blob: ea3e63fe34aaf6155955ba544eeb0eef53053b92 [file] [log] [blame]
Nick Lewyckye1121512013-01-24 01:12:16 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000015#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000016#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000018#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000019#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000020#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000021#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000022#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Benjamin Kramerf3ca26982014-05-10 16:31:55 +000023#include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000024#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
David Majnemerc729b0b2013-09-16 22:44:20 +000025#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000026#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
27#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
28#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
29#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
30#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000032#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000033#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +000034#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000035#include <algorithm>
David Blaikie8ad22e62014-05-01 23:01:41 +000036#include <cstdlib>
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000037
38namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000039using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000040
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000041/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000042static ExprResult
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000043CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
44 bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregore9d62932011-07-15 16:25:15 +000045 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
46 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
Richard Smith22262ab2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000047 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
Faisal Valid6676412013-06-15 11:54:37 +000048 return ExprError();
49 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
50 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
51 // called on both.
52 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
53 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
54 // being used.
55 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
Richard Smith22262ab2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000056 return ExprError();
John McCall113bee02012-03-10 09:33:50 +000057 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000058 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
59 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
60 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000061
62 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000063
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000064 ExprResult E = DRE;
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000065 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.get());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000066 if (E.isInvalid())
67 return ExprError();
Benjamin Kramer62b95d82012-08-23 21:35:17 +000068 return E;
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000069}
70
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000071static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
72 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +000073 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +000074 bool CStyle,
75 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Sam Panzer04390a62012-08-16 02:38:47 +000076
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +000077static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
78 QualType &ToType,
79 bool InOverloadResolution,
80 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
81 bool CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000082static OverloadingResult
83IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
84 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
85 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +000086 bool AllowExplicit,
87 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000088
89
90static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
91CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
92 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
93 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
94
95static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
96CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
97 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
98 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
99
100static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
101CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
102 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
103 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
104
105
106
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000107/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
108/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000109ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000110GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
111 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
112 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
113 ICC_Identity,
114 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
115 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
116 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000117 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000118 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
119 ICC_Promotion,
120 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000121 ICC_Promotion,
122 ICC_Conversion,
123 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000124 ICC_Conversion,
125 ICC_Conversion,
126 ICC_Conversion,
127 ICC_Conversion,
128 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000129 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000130 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000131 ICC_Conversion,
132 ICC_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000133 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000134 ICC_Conversion
135 };
136 return Category[(int)Kind];
137}
138
139/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
140/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
141ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
142 static const ImplicitConversionRank
143 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
144 ICR_Exact_Match,
145 ICR_Exact_Match,
146 ICR_Exact_Match,
147 ICR_Exact_Match,
148 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000149 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000150 ICR_Promotion,
151 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000152 ICR_Promotion,
153 ICR_Conversion,
154 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000155 ICR_Conversion,
156 ICR_Conversion,
157 ICR_Conversion,
158 ICR_Conversion,
159 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000160 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000161 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000162 ICR_Conversion,
163 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000164 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
165 ICR_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000166 ICR_Conversion,
167 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000168 };
169 return Rank[(int)Kind];
170}
171
172/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
173/// implicit conversion.
174const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000175 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000176 "No conversion",
177 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
178 "Array-to-pointer",
179 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000180 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000181 "Qualification",
182 "Integral promotion",
183 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000184 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000185 "Integral conversion",
186 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000187 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000188 "Floating-integral conversion",
189 "Pointer conversion",
190 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000191 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000192 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000193 "Derived-to-base conversion",
194 "Vector conversion",
195 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000196 "Complex-real conversion",
197 "Block Pointer conversion",
198 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000199 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000200 };
201 return Name[Kind];
202}
203
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000204/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
205/// sequence to the identity conversion.
206void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
207 First = ICK_Identity;
208 Second = ICK_Identity;
209 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000210 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000211 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000212 ReferenceBinding = false;
213 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000214 IsLvalueReference = true;
215 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
216 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000217 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000218 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000219 CopyConstructor = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000220}
221
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000222/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
223/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
224/// implicit conversions.
225ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
226 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
227 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
228 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
229 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
230 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
231 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
232 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
233 return Rank;
234}
235
236/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
237/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000239/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000240bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000241 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
242 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
243 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
244 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000245 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000246 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
247 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
248 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000249 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000250 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
251 return true;
252
253 return false;
254}
255
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000256/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
257/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
258/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
259/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000260bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000261StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000262isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000263 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000264 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000265
266 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
267 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
268 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
269 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
270 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
271
Douglas Gregor5d3d3fa2011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000272 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000273 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000274 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
275
276 return false;
277}
278
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000279/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
280/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
281static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
282 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
283 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
284 case CK_NoOp:
285 case CK_IntegralCast:
286 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
287 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
288 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
289 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
290 case CK_FloatingCast:
291 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
292 continue;
293
294 default:
295 return Converted;
296 }
297 }
298
299 return Converted;
300}
301
302/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
303/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
304///
305/// \param Ctx The AST context.
306/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
307/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
308/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000309/// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
310/// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000311NarrowingKind
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000312StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
313 const Expr *Converted,
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000314 APValue &ConstantValue,
315 QualType &ConstantType) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000316 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000317
318 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
319 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
320 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
321 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
322 switch (Second) {
323 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
324 //
325 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
326 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
327 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
328 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
329 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
330 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
331 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
332 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
333 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
334 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
335 if (Initializer &&
336 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
337 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
338 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
339 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
340 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
341 // And back.
342 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
343 bool ignored;
344 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
345 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
346 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
347 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
348 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000349 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000350 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
351 }
352 } else {
353 // Variables are always narrowings.
354 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
355 }
356 }
357 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
358
359 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
360 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
361 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
362 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
363 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
364 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
365 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
366 // FromType is larger than ToType.
367 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
368 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
369 // Constant!
370 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
371 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
372 // Convert the source value into the target type.
373 bool ignored;
374 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
375 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
376 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
377 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
378 // values that can be represented.
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000379 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
380 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000381 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000382 }
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000383 } else {
384 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
385 }
386 }
387 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
388
389 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
390 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
391 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
392 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
393 // value when converted back to the original type.
394 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
395 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
396 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
397 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
398 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
399 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
400 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
401 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
402 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
403 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
404 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
405 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
406 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
407
408 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
Richard Smith25a80d42012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000409 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
410 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000411 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
412 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
413 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
Richard Smith25a80d42012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000414 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
415 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
416 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
Richard Smith72cd8ea2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000417 }
418 bool Narrowing = false;
419 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
Richard Smith25a80d42012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000420 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
421 // narrowing.
422 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
Richard Smith72cd8ea2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000423 Narrowing = true;
Richard Smith25a80d42012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000424 } else {
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000425 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
426 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
427 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
428 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
429 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
430 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
431 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
432 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
433 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
434 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
435 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith72cd8ea2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000436 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
437 Narrowing = true;
438 }
439 if (Narrowing) {
440 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
441 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
442 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000443 }
444 }
445 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
446 }
447
448 default:
449 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
450 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
451 }
452}
453
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000454/// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000455/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000456void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000457 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000458 bool PrintedSomething = false;
459 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000460 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000461 PrintedSomething = true;
462 }
463
464 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
465 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000466 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000467 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000468 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000469
470 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000471 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000472 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000473 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000474 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000475 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000476 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000477 PrintedSomething = true;
478 }
479
480 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
481 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000482 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000483 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000484 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000485 PrintedSomething = true;
486 }
487
488 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000489 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000490 }
491}
492
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000493/// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000494/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000495void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000496 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000497 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000498 Before.dump();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000499 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000500 }
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000501 if (ConversionFunction)
502 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
503 else
504 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000505 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000506 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000507 After.dump();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000508 }
509}
510
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000511/// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000512/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000513void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000514 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Richard Smitha93f1022013-09-06 22:30:28 +0000515 if (isStdInitializerListElement())
516 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000517 switch (ConversionKind) {
518 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000519 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000520 Standard.dump();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000521 break;
522 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000523 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor9f2ed472013-11-08 02:16:10 +0000524 UserDefined.dump();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000525 break;
526 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000527 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000528 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000529 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000530 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000531 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000532 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000533 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000534 break;
535 }
536
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000537 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000538}
539
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000540void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
541 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
542}
543
544void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
545 conversions().~ConversionSet();
546}
547
548void
549AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
550 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
551 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
552 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
553}
554
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000555namespace {
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000556 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000557 // template argument information.
558 struct DFIArguments {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000559 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
560 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
561 };
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000562 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000563 // template parameter and template argument information.
564 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
565 TemplateParameter Param;
566 };
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000567}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000568
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000569/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
570/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000571DeductionFailureInfo MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
572 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
573 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
574 DeductionFailureInfo Result;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000575 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000576 Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000577 Result.Data = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000578 switch (TDK) {
579 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000580 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000581 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000582 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
583 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000584 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000585
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000586 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000587 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000588 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
589 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000590
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000591 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
592 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
593 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
594 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
595 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
596 Result.Data = Saved;
597 break;
598 }
599
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000600 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000601 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000602 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
603 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000604 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
605 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
606 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
607 Result.Data = Saved;
608 break;
609 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000610
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000611 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000612 Result.Data = Info.take();
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000613 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
614 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
615 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
616 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
617 Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
618 }
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000619 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000620
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000621 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000622 Result.Data = Info.Expression;
623 break;
624
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000625 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000626 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000627 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000628
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000629 return Result;
630}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000631
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000632void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000633 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
634 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000635 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000636 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
637 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000638 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
639 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000640 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000641 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000642 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000643
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000644 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000645 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000646 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000647 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000648 Data = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000649 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000650
651 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000652 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000653 Data = nullptr;
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000654 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
655 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
656 HasDiagnostic = false;
657 }
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000658 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000659
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000660 // Unhandled
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000661 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000662 break;
663 }
664}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000665
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000666PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000667 if (HasDiagnostic)
668 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000669 return nullptr;
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000670}
671
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000672TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000673 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
674 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000675 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000676 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000677 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
678 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000679 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000680 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
681 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000682 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000683
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000684 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000685 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000686 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000687
688 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000689 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000690 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000691
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000692 // Unhandled
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000693 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000694 break;
695 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000696
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000697 return TemplateParameter();
698}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000699
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000700TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000701 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000702 case Sema::TDK_Success:
703 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
704 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
705 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
706 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
707 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
708 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
709 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
710 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
711 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
712 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000713 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000714
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000715 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
716 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000717
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000718 // Unhandled
719 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
720 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000721 }
722
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000723 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000724}
725
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000726const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000727 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
728 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000729 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000730 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
731 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000732 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
733 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000734 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000735 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000736 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000737 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000738
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000739 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000740 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000741 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
742 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000743
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000744 // Unhandled
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000745 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000746 break;
747 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000748
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000749 return nullptr;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000750}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000751
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000752const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000753 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
754 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000755 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000756 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
757 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000758 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
759 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000760 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000761 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000762 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000763 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000764
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000765 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000766 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000767 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
768 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000769
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000770 // Unhandled
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000771 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000772 break;
773 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000774
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000775 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000776}
777
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000778Expr *DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() {
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000779 if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) ==
780 Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution)
781 return static_cast<Expr*>(Data);
782
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000783 return nullptr;
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000784}
785
Benjamin Kramer97e59492012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000786void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
Richard Smith0bf93aa2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000787 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
Benjamin Kramer02b08432012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000788 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
789 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Richard Smith0bf93aa2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000790 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
791 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
792 }
Benjamin Kramer97e59492012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000793}
794
795void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
796 destroyCandidates();
Benjamin Kramer0b9c5092012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000797 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000798 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000799 Functions.clear();
800}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000801
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000802namespace {
803 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
804 struct Entry {
805 Expr **Addr;
806 Expr *Saved;
807 };
808 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
809
810 public:
811 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
812 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
813 Entry entry = { &E, E };
814 Entries.push_back(entry);
815 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
816 }
817
818 void restore() {
819 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
820 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
821 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
822 }
823 };
824}
825
826/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
827/// preprocessing on the given expression.
828///
829/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
830/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
831///
832/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000833static bool
834checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
835 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) {
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000836 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
837 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
838 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
839 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
840
841 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
842 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
843 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
844 unbridgedCasts) {
845 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
846 return false;
847 }
848
849 // Go ahead and check everything else.
850 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
851 if (result.isInvalid())
852 return true;
853
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +0000854 E = result.get();
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000855 return false;
856 }
857
858 // Nothing to do.
859 return false;
860}
861
862/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
863/// placeholders.
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +0000864static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
865 MultiExprArg Args,
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000866 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +0000867 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
868 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000869 return true;
870
871 return false;
872}
873
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000874// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000875// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
876// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
877// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
878// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000879// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
880// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
881// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000882//
883// Example: Given the following input:
884//
885// void f(int, float); // #1
886// void f(int, int); // #2
887// int f(int, int); // #3
888//
889// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000890// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000891//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000892// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
893// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
894// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
895// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000896//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000897// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
898// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
899// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
900// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000901// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
902// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000903//
904// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
905// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
906// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
907// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000908Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000909Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
910 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000911 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000912 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000913 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
914
915 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
916 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
917 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
918
919 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
920 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
921 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
922
923 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
924 }
925
926 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
927 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
928 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
929 // function templates hide function templates with different
930 // return types or template parameter lists.
931 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
John McCallc70fca62013-04-03 21:19:47 +0000932 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
933 !New->getFriendObjectKind();
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000934
Alp Tokera2794f92014-01-22 07:29:52 +0000935 if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000936 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
937 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
938 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
939 continue;
940 }
941
Alp Tokera2794f92014-01-22 07:29:52 +0000942 if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) &&
943 !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
Rafael Espindola5bddd6a2013-04-15 12:49:13 +0000944 continue;
945
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000946 Match = *I;
947 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000948 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000949 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000950 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
951 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
952 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000953 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
954 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000955 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
956 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
957 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
958 // template instantiation.
959 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000960 // (C++ 13p1):
961 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
962 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000963 Match = *I;
964 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000965 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000966 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000967
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000968 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000969}
970
Richard Smithac974a32013-06-30 09:48:50 +0000971bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
972 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
973 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded.
974 if (New->isMain())
Rafael Espindola576127d2012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000975 return false;
Rafael Espindola7cf35ef2013-01-12 01:47:40 +0000976
David Majnemerc729b0b2013-09-16 22:44:20 +0000977 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded.
978 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
979 return false;
980
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000981 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
982 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
983
984 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
985 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
986 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +0000987 if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000988 return true;
989
990 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
Richard Smithac974a32013-06-30 09:48:50 +0000991 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
992 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000993
994 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
995 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
996 // in the signature, they are overloads.
997
998 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
999 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1000 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1001 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1002 return false;
1003
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00001004 const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1005 const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001006
1007 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1008 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1009 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1010 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00001011 (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() ||
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001012 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00001013 !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001014 return true;
1015
1016 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1017 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
1018 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1019 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1020 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1021 // signature.
1022 //
1023 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1024 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00001025 //
1026 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1027 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1028 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
Richard Smithac974a32013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001029 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1030 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1031 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00001032 OldType->getReturnType() != NewType->getReturnType()))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001033 return true;
1034
1035 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +00001036 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001037 //
1038 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1039 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1040 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1041 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1042 // can be overloaded.
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001043 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1044 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001045 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001046 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1047 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1048 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1049 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1050 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1051 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1052 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1053 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1054 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1055 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1056 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
Richard Smithac974a32013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001057 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001058 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
Richard Smithac974a32013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001059 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001060 }
1061 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001062 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001063
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001064 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1065 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1066 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1067 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
David Majnemer42350df2013-11-03 23:51:28 +00001068 unsigned OldQuals = OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001069 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00001070 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
Richard Smithe83b1d32013-06-25 18:46:26 +00001071 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001072 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
David Majnemer42350df2013-11-03 23:51:28 +00001073
1074 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'.
1075 OldQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1076 NewQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1077 if (OldQuals != NewQuals)
Richard Smith574f4f62013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001078 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001079 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001080
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00001081 // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature.
1082 for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr>
1083 NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1084 NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(),
1085 OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1086 OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>();
1087 NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) {
1088 if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE)
1089 return true;
1090 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1091 NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true);
1092 OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true);
Nick Lewyckyd950ae72014-01-21 01:30:30 +00001093 if (NewID != OldID)
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00001094 return true;
1095 }
1096
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001097 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1098 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001099}
1100
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00001101/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1102/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1103///
1104/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1105/// an available function, false otherwise.
1106bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1107 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1108}
1109
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001110/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1111///
1112/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1113/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1114static ImplicitConversionSequence
1115TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1116 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1117 bool AllowExplicit,
1118 bool InOverloadResolution,
1119 bool CStyle,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001120 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1121 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001122 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1123
1124 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1125 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1126 // we can perform.
1127 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1128 return ICS;
1129 }
1130
1131 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00001132 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(),
1133 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001134 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1135 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001136 AllowExplicit, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001137
1138 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1139 ICS.setUserDefined();
Ismail Pazarbasidf1a2802014-01-24 13:16:17 +00001140 ICS.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001141 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1142 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1143 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1144 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1145 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1146 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1147 // called for those cases.
1148 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1149 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1150 QualType FromCanon
1151 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1152 QualType ToCanon
1153 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1154 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1155 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1156 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1157 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1158 ICS.setStandard();
1159 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1160 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1161 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1162 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1163 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1164 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1165 }
1166 }
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001167 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1168 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1169 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1170 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1171 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1172 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1173 if (Cand->Viable)
1174 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1175 } else {
1176 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1177 }
1178
1179 return ICS;
1180}
1181
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001182/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1183/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1184/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1185/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001186///
1187/// void f(float f);
1188/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1189///
1190/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1191/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1192/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1193/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1194//
1195/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1196/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1197/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1198/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1199/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001200///
1201/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1202/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001203/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1204/// permitted.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001205///
1206/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1207/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1208/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001209static ImplicitConversionSequence
1210TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1211 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001212 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001213 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001214 bool CStyle,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001215 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1216 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001217 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001218 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001219 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001220 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001221 return ICS;
1222 }
1223
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001224 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001225 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001226 return ICS;
1227 }
1228
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001229 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1230 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1231 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1232 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1233 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1234 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1235 // called for those cases.
1236 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1237 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001238 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1239 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001240 ICS.setStandard();
1241 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1242 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1243 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001244
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001245 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1246 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1247 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1248 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00001249 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001250
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001251 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001252 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001253 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001254
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001255 return ICS;
1256 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001257
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001258 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1259 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001260 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1261 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001262}
1263
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001264ImplicitConversionSequence
1265Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1266 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1267 bool AllowExplicit,
1268 bool InOverloadResolution,
1269 bool CStyle,
1270 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1271 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1272 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1273 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001274 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1275 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001276}
1277
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001278/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001279/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001280/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1281/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1282/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001283ExprResult
1284Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001285 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001286 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001287 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001288}
1289
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001290ExprResult
1291Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001292 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001293 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001294 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1295 return ExprError();
1296
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001297 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1298 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001299 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001300 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
Fariborz Jahanian381edf52013-12-16 22:54:37 +00001301 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1)
1302 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getLocStart(),
1303 ToType, From->getType(), From);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001304 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1305 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1306 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001307 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001308 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001309 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1310 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001311 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1312}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001313
1314/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001315/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001316bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1317 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001318 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1319 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001320
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001321 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1322 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1323 // - a pointer
1324 // - a member pointer
1325 // - a block pointer
1326 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1327 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1328 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1329 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1330 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1331 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1332 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1333 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1334 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1335 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1336 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1337 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1338 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1339 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1340 } else {
1341 return false;
1342 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001343
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001344 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1345 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1346 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1347 return false;
1348 }
1349
1350 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1351 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1352 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1353
1354 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1355 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1356 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1357
1358 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001359 return true;
1360}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001361
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001362/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1363/// vector conversion.
1364///
1365/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1366/// conversion.
John McCall9b595db2014-02-04 23:58:19 +00001367static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001368 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001369 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1370 // conversion.
1371 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1372 return false;
1373
1374 // Identical types require no conversions.
John McCall9b595db2014-02-04 23:58:19 +00001375 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001376 return false;
1377
1378 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1379 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1380 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1381 // identity conversion.
1382 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1383 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001384
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001385 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001386 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001387 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1388 return true;
1389 }
1390 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001391
1392 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1393 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1394 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1395 // same size
1396 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
John McCall9b595db2014-02-04 23:58:19 +00001397 if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1398 S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001399 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1400 return true;
1401 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001402 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001403
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001404 return false;
1405}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001406
Douglas Gregorf9e36cc2012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001407static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1408 bool InOverloadResolution,
1409 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1410 bool CStyle);
Douglas Gregorc79862f2012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001411
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001412/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1413/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1414/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1415/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1416/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1417/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1418/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1419/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001420static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1421 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001422 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001423 bool CStyle,
1424 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001425 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001426
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001427 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001428 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001429 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001430 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00001431 SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001432
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001433 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001434 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001435 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001436 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001437 return false;
1438
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001439 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001440 }
1441
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001442 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1443 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1444 // (C++ 4p1).
1445
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001446 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001447 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1448 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001449 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001450 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001451 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1452 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1453 FromType = Fn->getType();
Ehsan Akhgaric3ad3ba2014-07-22 20:20:14 +00001454 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001455
1456 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1457 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1458 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1459 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1460 QualType resultTy;
1461 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001462 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001463 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1464 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1465 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1466 return false;
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001467 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001468
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001469 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1470 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1471 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1472 // expression.
1473 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1474 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1475 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1476 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1477 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1478 == UO_AddrOf &&
1479 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1480 const Type *ClassType
1481 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1482 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruth7750f762011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001483 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1484 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1485 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001486 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1487 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1488 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001489
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001490 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001491 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1492 FromType,
1493 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001494 } else {
1495 return false;
1496 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001497 }
John McCall154a2fd2011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001498 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1499 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1500 // be converted to a prvalue.
1501 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001502 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001503 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001504 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001505 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001506
Douglas Gregorc79862f2012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001507 // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1508 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1509 // of the type of the lvalue ...
1510 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1511 FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1512
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001513 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1514 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001515 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1516 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001517 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001518 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1519 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001520 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001521
1522 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1523 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1524 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001525 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001526
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001527 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00001528 // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4)
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001529 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001530
1531 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1532 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1533 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1534 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001535 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1536 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001537 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001538 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001539 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001540 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001541 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001542 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001543 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001544
1545 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1546 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1547 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001548 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001549 } else {
1550 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001551 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001552 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001553 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001554
1555 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1556 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1557 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1558 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001559 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1560 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001561 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001562 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001563 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001564 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1565 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001566 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001567 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001568 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001569 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001570 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001571 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001572 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001573 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001574 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001575 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001576 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001577 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1578 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001579 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1580 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1581 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1582 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1583 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1584 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1585 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1586 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1587 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001588 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001589 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001590 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001591 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001592 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Richard Smithb8a98242013-05-10 20:29:50 +00001593 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001594 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001595 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1596 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001597 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1598 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001599 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1600 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1601 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001602 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001603 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1604 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1605 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001606 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001607 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001608 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001609 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001610 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001611 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001612 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001613 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001614 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1615 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1616 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1617 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001618 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1619 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001620 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001621 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001622 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001623 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001624 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001625 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001626 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001627 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall9b595db2014-02-04 23:58:19 +00001628 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001629 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1630 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001631 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001632 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001633 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001634 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001635 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001636 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001637 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1638 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001639 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1640 InOverloadResolution,
1641 SCS, CStyle)) {
1642 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1643 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregorf9e36cc2012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001644 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1645 CStyle)) {
1646 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorc79862f2012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001647 // appropriately.
1648 return true;
Guy Benyei259f9f42013-02-07 16:05:33 +00001649 } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1650 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1651 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1652 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1653 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001654 } else {
1655 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001656 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001657 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001658 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001659
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001660 QualType CanonFrom;
1661 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001662 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001663 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1664 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1665 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001666 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001667 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001668 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001669 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1670 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001671 } else {
1672 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001673 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1674
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001675 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001676 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1677 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1678 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001679 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1680 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001681 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001682 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Matt Arsenault7d36c012013-02-26 21:15:54 +00001683 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001684 FromType = ToType;
1685 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1686 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001687 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001688 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001689
1690 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1691 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001692 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001693 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001694
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001695 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001696}
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001697
1698static bool
1699IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1700 QualType &ToType,
1701 bool InOverloadResolution,
1702 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1703 bool CStyle) {
1704
1705 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1706 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1707 return false;
1708 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1709 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1710 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00001711 for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001712 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1713 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001714 ToType = it->getType();
1715 return true;
1716 }
1717 }
1718 return false;
1719}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001720
1721/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1722/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1723/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1724/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001725bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001726 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001727 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001728 if (!To) {
1729 return false;
1730 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001731
1732 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1733 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1734 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1735 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1736 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001737 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1738 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001739 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1740 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1741 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1742 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001743 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001744 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001745 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001746 }
1747
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001748 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1749 }
1750
Richard Smithb9c5a602012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001751 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001752 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1753 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1754 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1755 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1756 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001757 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001758 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001759 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001760 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1761 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001762 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Richard Smithb9c5a602012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001763 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1764 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1765 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1766 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1767 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1768 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001769 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1770 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1771 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1772 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1773 return false;
1774
Richard Smithb9c5a602012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001775 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1776 // even if that's not the promoted type.
1777 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1778 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1779 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1780 IsIntegralPromotion(From, Underlying, ToType);
1781 }
1782
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001783 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001784 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00001785 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001786 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1787 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001788 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001789
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001790 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001791 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1792 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1793 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001794 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001795 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001796 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001797 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001798 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001799 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001800 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001801 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1802 // unsigned.
David Majnemerfa01a582011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001803 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001804 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001805
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001806 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1807 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001808 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1809 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001810 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1811 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001812 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001813 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001814 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1815 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001816 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001817 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1818 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1819 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1820 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001821 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001822 }
1823 }
1824 }
1825
1826 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1827 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1828 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1829 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1830 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1831 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1832 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001833 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1834 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001835 using llvm::APSInt;
1836 if (From)
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00001837 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001838 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001839 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001840 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1841 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1842 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001843
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001844 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1845 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1846 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1847 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1848 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001849
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001850 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1851 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1852 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1853 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1854 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001855
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001856 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001857 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001858 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001859
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001860 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1861 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001862 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001863 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001864 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001865
1866 return false;
1867}
1868
1869/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1870/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1871/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001872bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001873 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1874 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001875 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1876 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001877 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1878 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1879 return true;
1880
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001881 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1882 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1883 // double is promoted to long double [...].
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001884 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001885 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1886 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1887 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1888 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001889
1890 // Half can be promoted to float.
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00001891 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
1892 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001893 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1894 return true;
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001895 }
1896
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001897 return false;
1898}
1899
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001900/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1901///
1902/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1903/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001904/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001905bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001906 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001907 if (!FromComplex)
1908 return false;
1909
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001910 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001911 if (!ToComplex)
1912 return false;
1913
1914 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001915 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00001916 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001917 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001918}
1919
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001920/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1921/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1922/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1923/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1924/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001925///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001926static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001927BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001928 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001929 ASTContext &Context,
1930 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001931 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1932 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1933 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001934
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001935 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1936 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001937 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001938
1939 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001940 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001941 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001942 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001943
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001944 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1945 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1946
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001947 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001948 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001949 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001950 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001951 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001952
1953 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1954 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001955 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1956 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001957 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1958 }
1959
1960 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001961 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1962 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001963
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001964 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1965 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1966 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001967}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001968
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001969static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001970 bool InOverloadResolution,
1971 ASTContext &Context) {
1972 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1973 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1974 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001975 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001976 return !InOverloadResolution;
1977
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001978 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1979 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1980 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001981}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001982
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001983/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1984/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1985/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1986/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1987/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1988/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001989///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001990/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1991/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1992/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1993/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1994/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1995/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001996/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1997/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1998/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001999bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00002000 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002001 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002002 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002003 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002004 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2005 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002006 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002007
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002008 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2009 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002010 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00002011 ConvertedType = ToType;
2012 return true;
2013 }
2014
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002015 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2016 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002017 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002018 ConvertedType = ToType;
2019 return true;
2020 }
2021 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2022 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002023 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002024 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002025 ConvertedType = ToType;
2026 return true;
2027 }
2028
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002029 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2030 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002031 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002032 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002033 ConvertedType = ToType;
2034 return true;
2035 }
2036
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002037 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002038 if (!ToTypePtr)
2039 return false;
2040
2041 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002042 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002043 ConvertedType = ToType;
2044 return true;
2045 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00002046
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002047 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002048 // , including objective-c pointers.
2049 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002050 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002051 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002052 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2053 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2054 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002055 ToType, Context);
2056 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002057 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002058 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002059 if (!FromTypePtr)
2060 return false;
2061
2062 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002063
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002064 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00002065 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2066 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2067 return false;
2068
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002069 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2070 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2071 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00002072 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2073 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002074 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002075 ToPointeeType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002076 ToType, Context,
2077 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002078 return true;
2079 }
2080
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002081 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002082 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002083 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2084 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2085 ToPointeeType,
2086 ToType, Context);
2087 return true;
2088 }
2089
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002090 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2091 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002092 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002093 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002094 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002095 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002096 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002097 return true;
2098 }
2099
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002100 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002101 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002102 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2103 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2104 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2105 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2106 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2107 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2108 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2109 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
2110 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002111 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2112 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002113 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002114 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00002115 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002116 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002117 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002118 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002119 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002120 ToType, Context);
2121 return true;
2122 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002123
Fariborz Jahanianbc2ee932011-04-14 20:33:36 +00002124 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2125 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2126 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2127 ToPointeeType,
2128 ToType, Context);
2129 return true;
2130 }
2131
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002132 return false;
2133}
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002134
2135/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2136static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2137 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2138
2139 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2140 if (TQs == Qs)
2141 return T;
2142
2143 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2144 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2145
2146 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2147}
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002148
2149/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2150/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2151/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002152bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002153 QualType& ConvertedType,
2154 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002155 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002156 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002157
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002158 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2159 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2160
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002161 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002162 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2163 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002164 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002165 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002166
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002167 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002168 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2169 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2170 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2171 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2172 return false;
2173
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002174 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002175 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002176 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002177 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002178 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002179 return true;
2180 }
2181 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002182 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002183 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002184 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002185 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002186 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002187 return true;
2188 }
2189 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2190 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2191 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002192 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2193 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002194 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002195 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2196 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2197 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002198 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002199 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2200 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002201 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002202 return true;
2203 }
2204
2205 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2206 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2207 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2208 // complain about it.
2209 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002210 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002211 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2212 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002213 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002214 return true;
2215 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002216 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002217 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002218 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002219 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002220 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002221 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002222 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002223 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002224 // to a block pointer type.
2225 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002226 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002227 return true;
2228 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002229 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002230 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002231 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002232 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002233 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002234 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002235 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002236 return true;
2237 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002238 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002239 return false;
2240
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002241 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002242 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002243 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002244 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2245 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002246 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2247 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002248 return false;
2249
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002250 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2251 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2252 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2253 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2254 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2255 // We always complain about this conversion.
2256 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002257 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002258 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002259 return true;
2260 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002261 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2262 // as in I* to id.
2263 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2264 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2265 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2266 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002267
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002268 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002269 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002270 return true;
2271 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002272
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002273 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002274 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2275 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2276 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002277 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002278 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002279 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002280 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002281 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2282 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2283 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2284 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2285 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2286 return false;
2287
2288 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2289 // function types are obviously different.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002290 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002291 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2292 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2293 return false;
2294
2295 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002296 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) ==
2297 Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002298 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002299 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2300 ToFunctionType->getReturnType(),
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002301 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2302 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2303 HasObjCConversion = true;
2304 } else {
2305 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2306 return false;
2307 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002308
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002309 // Check argument types.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002310 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002311 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002312 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2313 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002314 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2315 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2316 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2317 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2318 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2319 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2320 HasObjCConversion = true;
2321 } else {
2322 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2323 return false;
2324 }
2325 }
2326
2327 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2328 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2329 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002330 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002331 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2332 return true;
2333 }
2334 }
2335
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002336 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002337}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002338
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002339/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2340/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2341///
2342/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2343///
2344/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2345///
2346/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2347/// this conversion.
2348bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2349 QualType &ConvertedType) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002350 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002351 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2352 return false;
2353
2354 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2355 QualType ToPointee;
2356 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2357 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2358 else
2359 return false;
2360
2361 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2362 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2363 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002364 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002365 return false;
2366
2367 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2368 QualType FromPointee;
2369 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2370 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2371 else
2372 return false;
2373
2374 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2375 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2376 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2377 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2378 return false;
2379
2380 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2381 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2382 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2383 return false;
2384
2385 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2386 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2387 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2388 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2389
2390 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2391 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2392 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2393 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2394 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2395 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2396 IncompatibleObjC))
2397 return false;
2398
2399 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2400 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2401 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2402 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2403 return true;
2404}
2405
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002406bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2407 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2408 QualType ToPointeeType;
2409 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2410 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2411 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2412 else
2413 return false;
2414
2415 QualType FromPointeeType;
2416 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2417 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2418 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2419 else
2420 return false;
2421 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2422 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2423 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2424
2425 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2426 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2427 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2428 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2429
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002430 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2431 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002432
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002433 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002434 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002435
2436 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2437 // function types are obviously different.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002438 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002439 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2440 return false;
2441
2442 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2443 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2444 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2445 return false;
2446
2447 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002448 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2449 ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002450 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2451 } else {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002452 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType();
2453 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType();
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002454 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002455 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2456 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2457
2458 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2459 // OK exact match.
2460 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2461 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2462 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2463 return false;
2464 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2465 }
2466 else
2467 return false;
2468 }
2469
2470 // Check argument types.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002471 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002472 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2473 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002474 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2475 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002476 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2477 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2478 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2479 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2480 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2481 return false;
2482 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2483 } else
2484 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2485 return false;
2486 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002487 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2488 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2489 ToFunctionType))
2490 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian600ba202011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002491
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002492 ConvertedType = ToType;
2493 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002494}
2495
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002496enum {
2497 ft_default,
2498 ft_different_class,
2499 ft_parameter_arity,
2500 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2501 ft_return_type,
2502 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2503};
2504
2505/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2506/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2507/// parameter types, and different return types.
2508void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2509 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002510 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2511 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2512 PDiag << ft_default;
2513 return;
2514 }
2515
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002516 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2517 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2518 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2519 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Richard Trieu9098c9f2014-05-22 01:39:16 +00002520 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002521 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2522 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2523 return;
2524 }
2525 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2526 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002527 }
2528
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002529 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2530 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2531 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2532 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2533
2534 // Remove references.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002535 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2536 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2537
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002538 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2539 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2540 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2541 PDiag << ft_default;
2542 return;
2543 }
2544
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002545 // No extra info for same types.
2546 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2547 PDiag << ft_default;
2548 return;
2549 }
2550
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002551 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2552 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2553
2554 // Both types need to be function types.
2555 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2556 PDiag << ft_default;
2557 return;
2558 }
2559
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002560 if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) {
2561 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams()
2562 << FromFunction->getNumParams();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002563 return;
2564 }
2565
2566 // Handle different parameter types.
2567 unsigned ArgPos;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002568 if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002569 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002570 << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos)
2571 << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos);
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002572 return;
2573 }
2574
2575 // Handle different return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002576 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(),
2577 ToFunction->getReturnType())) {
2578 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType()
2579 << FromFunction->getReturnType();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002580 return;
2581 }
2582
2583 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2584 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2585 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2586 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2587 return;
2588 }
2589
2590 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2591 PDiag << ft_default;
2592}
2593
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002594/// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregor2039ca02011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002595/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Eli Friedman5f508952013-06-18 22:41:37 +00002596/// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different,
2597/// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002598bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
2599 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2600 unsigned *ArgPos) {
2601 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(),
2602 N = NewType->param_type_begin(),
2603 E = OldType->param_type_end();
2604 O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
Richard Trieu4b03d982013-08-09 21:42:32 +00002605 if (!Context.hasSameType(O->getUnqualifiedType(),
2606 N->getUnqualifiedType())) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002607 if (ArgPos)
2608 *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin();
Larisse Voufo4154f462013-08-06 03:57:41 +00002609 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002610 }
2611 }
2612 return true;
2613}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002614
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002615/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2616/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002617/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002618/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2619/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2620/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002621bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002622 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002623 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002624 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002625 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002626 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002627
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002628 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2629
David Blaikie1c7c8f72012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002630 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3e3305d2014-02-02 05:26:43 +00002631 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
David Blaikie1c7c8f72012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002632 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2633 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2634 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2635 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2636 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2637 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2638 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2639 << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2640 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002641 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2642 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002643 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2644 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002645
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002646 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2647 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002648 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2649 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002650 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2651 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002652 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002653 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002654 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002655
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002656 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002657 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002658 }
2659 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002660 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2661 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2662 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2663 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002664 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2665 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2666 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002667 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002668 return false;
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002669 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2670 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2671 } else {
2672 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002673 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002674 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2675 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2676 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002677 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002678
2679 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2680 // reasons.
2681 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2682 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2683
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002684 return false;
2685}
2686
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002687/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2688/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2689/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2690/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2691/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2692bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002693 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002694 bool InOverloadResolution,
2695 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002696 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002697 if (!ToTypePtr)
2698 return false;
2699
2700 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002701 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2702 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2703 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002704 ConvertedType = ToType;
2705 return true;
2706 }
2707
2708 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002709 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002710 if (!FromTypePtr)
2711 return false;
2712
2713 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2714 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2715 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2716 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002717
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002718 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002719 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002720 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002721 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2722 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2723 return true;
2724 }
2725
2726 return false;
2727}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002728
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002729/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2730/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002731/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002732/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2733/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2734/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002735bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002736 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002737 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002738 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002739 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002740 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002741 if (!FromPtrType) {
2742 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002743 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002744 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002745 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002746 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002747 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002748 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002749
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002750 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002751 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2752 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002753
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002754 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2755 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002756
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002757 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2758 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2759 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002760
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002761 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002762 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002763 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2764 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2765 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2766 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002767
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002768 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2769 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002770 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2771 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2772 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2773 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002774 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002775
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002776 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002777 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2778 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2779 << From->getSourceRange();
2780 return true;
2781 }
2782
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002783 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002784 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2785 Paths.front(),
2786 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002787
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002788 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002789 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002790 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002791 return false;
2792}
2793
Douglas Gregorc9f019a2013-11-08 02:04:24 +00002794/// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given
2795/// qualifiers sets is nontrivial.
2796static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals,
2797 Qualifiers ToQuals) {
2798 // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial.
2799 if (ToQuals.hasConst() &&
2800 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone)
2801 return false;
2802
2803 return true;
2804}
2805
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002806/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2807/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2808/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002809///
2810/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2811/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2812/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002813bool
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002814Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002815 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002816 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2817 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002818 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2819
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002820 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2821 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002822 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002823 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002824
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002825 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2826 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2827 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2828 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002829 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002830 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002831 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2832 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2833 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002834 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002835 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2836 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002837 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002838
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002839 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2840 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2841
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002842 // Objective-C ARC:
2843 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2844 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2845 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2846 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc9f019a2013-11-08 02:04:24 +00002847 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals))
2848 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002849 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2850 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2851 } else {
2852 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2853 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2854 return false;
2855 }
2856 }
2857
Douglas Gregorf30053d2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002858 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2859 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2860 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2861 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2862 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2863 }
2864
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002865 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2866 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002867 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002868 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002869
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002870 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2871 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002872 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002873 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002874 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002875
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002876 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2877 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002878 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002879 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002880 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002881
2882 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2883 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2884 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2885 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2886 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002887 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002888}
2889
Douglas Gregorc79862f2012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002890/// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2891/// atomic type.
2892///
2893/// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2894/// sequence to finish the conversion.
Douglas Gregorf9e36cc2012-04-12 20:48:09 +00002895static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2896 bool InOverloadResolution,
2897 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2898 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregorc79862f2012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002899 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2900 if (!ToAtomic)
2901 return false;
2902
2903 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2904 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2905 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2906 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2907 return false;
2908
2909 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2910 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2911 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2912 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2913 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2914 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2915 return true;
2916}
2917
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002918static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2919 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2920 QualType Type) {
2921 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2922 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002923 if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) {
2924 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0);
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002925 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2926 return true;
2927 }
2928 return false;
2929}
2930
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002931static OverloadingResult
2932IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2933 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2934 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2935 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2936 bool AllowExplicit) {
David Blaikieff7d47a2012-12-19 00:45:41 +00002937 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2938 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002939 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2940 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2941 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2942
2943 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00002944 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002945 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2946 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2947 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2948 Constructor
2949 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2950 else
2951 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2952
2953 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2954 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2955 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2956 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002957 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2958 // suppress conversions.
2959 bool SuppressUserConversions =
2960 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002961 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2962 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00002963 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002964 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002965 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002966 else
2967 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002968 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002969 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002970 }
2971 }
2972
2973 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2974
2975 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2976 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2977 case OR_Success: {
2978 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2979 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002980 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2981 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2982 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2983 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2984 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2985 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2986 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2987 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2988 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2989 return OR_Success;
2990 }
2991
2992 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2993 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2994 case OR_Deleted:
2995 return OR_Deleted;
2996 case OR_Ambiguous:
2997 return OR_Ambiguous;
2998 }
2999
3000 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3001}
3002
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003003/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3004/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3005/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3006/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3007/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3008/// false and User is unspecified.
3009///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003010/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3011/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3012/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003013///
3014/// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should
3015/// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit
3016/// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003017static OverloadingResult
3018IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003019 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3020 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003021 bool AllowExplicit,
3022 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor2ee1d992013-11-08 01:20:25 +00003023 assert(AllowExplicit || !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003024
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003025 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3026 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3027
3028 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3029 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003030 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003031 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3032 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3033 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3034 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3035 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3036 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3037 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3038 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003039 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003040 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003041 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003042 ConstructorsOnly = true;
3043
Benjamin Kramer90633e32012-11-23 17:04:52 +00003044 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7a6f2a32011-04-22 17:45:37 +00003045 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
3046 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
3047 // to try to recover.
3048 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00003049 // We're not going to find any constructors.
3050 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3051 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003052
3053 Expr **Args = &From;
3054 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3055 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003056 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Benjamin Kramer60509af2013-09-09 14:48:42 +00003057 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work.
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003058 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3059 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3060 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3061 return Result;
3062 // Never mind.
3063 CandidateSet.clear();
3064
3065 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3066 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003067 Args = InitList->getInits();
3068 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3069 ListInitializing = true;
3070 }
3071
David Blaikieff7d47a2012-12-19 00:45:41 +00003072 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
3073 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003074 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003075 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3076 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3077
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003078 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00003079 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003080 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003081 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003082 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003083 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003084 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3085 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003086 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003087
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003088 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3089 if (ListInitializing)
3090 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3091 else
3092 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3093 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redld9170b02012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003094 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3095 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3096 SuppressUserConversions = false;
3097 if (NumArgs == 1) {
3098 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3099 // suppress conversions.
Sebastian Redle5417162012-03-27 18:33:03 +00003100 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3101 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redld9170b02012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003102 }
3103 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003104 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003105 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00003106 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003107 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redld9170b02012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003108 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003109 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00003110 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3111 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003112 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003113 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redld9170b02012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003114 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003115 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003116 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003117 }
3118 }
3119
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003120 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003121 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003122 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00003123 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003124 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003125 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003126 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003127 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3128 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00003129 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
3130 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
3131 Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3132 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
3133 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003134 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3135 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003136 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3137 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3138 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3139
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003140 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3141 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003142 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3143 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003144 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003145 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003146
3147 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3148 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003149 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3150 ActingContext, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003151 CandidateSet,
3152 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003153 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003154 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003155 From, ToType, CandidateSet,
3156 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003157 }
3158 }
3159 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003160 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003161
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003162 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3163
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003164 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003165 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003166 case OR_Success:
3167 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3168 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3169 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3170 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3171 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3172 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3173 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3174 // the argument of the constructor.
3175 //
3176 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003177 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3178 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3179 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3180 } else {
3181 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3182 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3183 else {
3184 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3185 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3186 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003187 }
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003188 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003189 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003190 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003191 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3192 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3193 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3194 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003195 }
3196 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003197 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3198 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3199 //
3200 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3201 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3202 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3203 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3204 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003205 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003206 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003207 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003208 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003209
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003210 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3211 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3212 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3213 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3214 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3215 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3216 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3217 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3218 // 13.3.3.1).
3219 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3220 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003221 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003222 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003223
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003224 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3225 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3226 case OR_Deleted:
3227 // No conversion here! We're done.
3228 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003229
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003230 case OR_Ambiguous:
3231 return OR_Ambiguous;
3232 }
3233
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003234 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003235}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003236
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003237bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003238Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003239 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00003240 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(),
3241 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003242 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003243 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003244 CandidateSet, false, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003245 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003246 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3247 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
Larisse Voufo64cf3ef2013-06-27 01:50:25 +00003248 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) {
Larisse Voufo70bb43a2013-06-27 03:36:30 +00003249 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType,
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003250 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
Larisse Voufo64cf3ef2013-06-27 01:50:25 +00003251 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003252 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3253 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3254 } else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003255 return false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003256 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003257 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003258}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003259
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003260/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3261/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3262/// is possible.
3263static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003264compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1,
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003265 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
Richard Smith2bf7fdb2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00003266 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003267 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003268
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003269 // Objective-C++:
3270 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003271 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003272 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3273 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3274 // to keep code working.
Ted Kremenek8d265c22014-04-01 07:23:18 +00003275 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003276 if (!Conv1)
3277 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003278
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003279 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3280 if (!Conv2)
3281 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003282
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003283 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3284 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3285 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3286 if (Block1 != Block2)
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003287 return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3288 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003289 }
3290
3291 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3292}
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003293
3294static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(
3295 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
3296 return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) ||
3297 (ICS.isUserDefined() &&
3298 ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr);
3299}
3300
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003301/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3302/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3303/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003304static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3305CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3306 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3307 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003308{
3309 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3310 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3311 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3312 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3313 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3314 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3315 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3316 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003317 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003318 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3319 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3320 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3321 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3322 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00003323
3324 // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has
3325 // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at
3326 // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse
3327 // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the
3328 // standard. For example:
3329 //
3330 // int &f(...); // #1
3331 // void f(char*); // #2
3332 // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); }
3333 //
3334 // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function.
3335 // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis
3336 // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there
3337 // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't
3338 // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11.
3339 // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued
3340 // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11.
3341
3342 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
3343 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) !=
3344 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2))
3345 return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1)
3346 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3347 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3348
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003349 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3350 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003351 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003352 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003353
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003354 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3355 // the same kind.
3356 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3357 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3358
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003359 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3360 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3361
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003362 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3363 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3364 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003365 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003366 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3367 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003368 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003369 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3370 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3371 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3372 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3373 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3374 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003375 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003376 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003377 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3378 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3379 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003380 else
3381 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3382 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3383 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003384 }
3385
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003386 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3387 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3388 // for some X and L2 does not.
3389 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
Richard Smitha93f1022013-09-06 22:30:28 +00003390 !ICS1.isBad()) {
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003391 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3392 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3393 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3394 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3395 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3396 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003397 }
3398
3399 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003400}
3401
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003402static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3403 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3404 Qualifiers Quals;
3405 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003406 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003407 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003408
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003409 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3410}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003411
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003412// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3413// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3414static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3415compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3416 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3417 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3418 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3419 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3420
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003421 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003422 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor377c1092011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003423 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3424 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3425 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3426 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003427
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003428 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3429 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3430 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3431 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3432 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3433 else
3434 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003435 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003436 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3437
3438 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3439 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3440 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3441 }
3442
3443 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3444 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3445 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3446 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3447
3448 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3449 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3450 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3451 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003452
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003453 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3454}
3455
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003456/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3457/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00003458static bool
3459isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3460 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003461 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3462 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3463 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003464 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003465 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003466 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003467 // reference*.
3468 //
3469 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3470 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3471 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3472 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3473 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003474 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3475 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3476 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003477
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003478 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3479 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3480 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00003481 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue);
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003482}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003483
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003484/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3485/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3486/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003487static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3488CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3489 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3490 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003491{
3492 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3493 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3494
3495 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3496 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3497 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3498 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3499 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003500 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003501 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003502 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003503
3504 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3505 // defined below), or, if not that,
3506 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3507 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3508 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3509 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3510 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3511 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003512
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003513 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3514 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3515 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003516
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003517 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3518 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3519 // that is such a conversion.
3520 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3521 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3522 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3523 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3524
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003525 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3526 //
3527 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003528 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3529 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3530 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003531 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003532 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003533 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003534 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003535 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3536 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3537 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003538 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3539 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003540 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3541 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3542 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003543 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003544 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003545 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003546 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3547 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003548 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3549 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3550 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003551 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3552 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003553
3554 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3555 // conversion, if we need to.
3556 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003557 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003558 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003559 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003560
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003561 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3562 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003563
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003564 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003565 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003566 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003567 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3568
3569 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3570 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003571 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3572 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3573 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3574 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3575 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3576 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3577 FromObjCPtr2);
3578 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3579 FromObjCPtr1);
3580 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3581 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3582 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3583 }
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003584 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003585 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003586
3587 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3588 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003589 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003590 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003591 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003592
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003593 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003594 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3595 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3596 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3597 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3598 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003599
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003600 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3601 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3602 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3603 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3604 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3605 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003606 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3607 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003608 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3609 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003610 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003611 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3612 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003613 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003614 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3615 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3616 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3617 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3618 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3619 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3620 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3621 }
3622
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003623 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3624 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003625 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003626 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003627 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003628 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003629 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3630 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3631 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003632 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003633 }
3634 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003635
Francois Pichet08d2fa02011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003636 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3637 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3638 // is between types of the same size.
3639 // For example:
3640 // void f(float);
3641 // void f(int);
3642 // int main {
3643 // long a;
3644 // f(a);
3645 // }
3646 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3647 // as clang will do in standard mode.
Alp Tokerbfa39342014-01-14 12:51:41 +00003648 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3649 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
Francois Pichet08d2fa02011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003650 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
Alp Tokerbfa39342014-01-14 12:51:41 +00003651 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
Francois Pichet08d2fa02011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003652 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3653
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003654 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3655}
3656
3657/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3658/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003659/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3660ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003661CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3662 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3663 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003664 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003665 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3666 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3667 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3668 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3669 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3670 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3671 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3672 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3673
3674 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3675 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003676 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3677 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003678 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3679 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003680 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003681 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3682 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003683
3684 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3685 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003686 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003687 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3688
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003689 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3690 // for comparison.
3691 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003692 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003693 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003694 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003695
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003696 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003697 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003698
3699 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3700 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3701 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3702 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3703 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3704 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3705 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3706 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3707 }
3708
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003709 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003710 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3711 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3712 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003713 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003714 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3715 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3716 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3717 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3718 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3719 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3720 // about how the sequences rank.
3721 ;
3722 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3723 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3724 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3725 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3726 // qualifiers.
3727 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003728
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003729 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3730 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3731 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3732 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3733 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3734 // qualifiers.
3735 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003736
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003737 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3738 } else {
3739 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3740 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3741 }
3742
3743 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003744 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003745 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003746 }
3747
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003748 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3749 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3750 switch (Result) {
3751 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003752 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003753 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3754 break;
3755
3756 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3757 break;
3758
3759 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003760 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003761 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3762 break;
3763 }
3764
3765 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003766}
3767
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003768/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3769/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003770/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3771/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3772/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003773ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003774CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3775 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3776 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003777 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003778 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003779 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003780 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003781
3782 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3783 // conversion, if we need to.
3784 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003785 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003786 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003787 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003788
3789 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003790 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3791 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3792 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3793 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003794
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003795 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003796 //
3797 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3798 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003799 //
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003800 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003801 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003802 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3803 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3804 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3805 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003806 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003807 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003808 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003809 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003810 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003811 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003812 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003813 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003814
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003815 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003816 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003817 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003818 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003819 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003820 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3821 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003822
3823 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3824 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003825 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003826 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003827 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003828 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003829 }
3830 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3831 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3832 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3833 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3834 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3835 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3836 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3837 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3838 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3839 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3840
3841 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3842 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3843 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3844 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3845 // Objective-C pointer types.
3846 bool FromAssignLeft
3847 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3848 bool FromAssignRight
3849 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3850 bool ToAssignLeft
3851 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3852 bool ToAssignRight
3853 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3854
3855 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3856 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3857 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3858 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3859 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3860 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3861 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3862 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3863
3864 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3865 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3866 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3867 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3868 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3869 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3870
3871 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3872 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3873 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3874 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3875 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3876 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3877 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3878 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3879
3880 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3881 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3882 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3883 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3884 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3885 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003886
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003887 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3888 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3889 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3890 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3891 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3892 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3893
3894 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3895 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3896 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3897 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3898 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003899 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003900 }
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003901
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003902 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003903 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3904 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3905 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003906 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003907 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003908 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003909 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003910 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003911 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003912 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003913 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3914 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3915 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3916 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3917 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3918 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3919 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3920 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3921 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003922 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003923 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003924 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003925 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003926 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003927 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3928 }
3929 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3930 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003931 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003932 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003933 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003934 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3935 }
3936 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003937
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003938 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003939 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003940 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3941 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3942 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003943 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3944 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3945 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003946 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003947 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003948 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3949 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003950
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003951 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003952 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3953 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3954 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003955 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3956 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3957 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003958 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003959 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003960 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3961 }
3962 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003963
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003964 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3965}
3966
Douglas Gregor45bb4832013-03-26 23:36:30 +00003967/// \brief Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
3968/// C++ class.
3969static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
3970 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3971 return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
3972
3973 return true;
3974}
3975
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003976/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3977/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3978/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3979/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3980/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3981/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3982/// type being initialized.
3983Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3984Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3985 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003986 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003987 bool &ObjCConversion,
3988 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003989 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3990 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3991 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3992
3993 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3994 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3995 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3996 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3997 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3998
3999 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4000 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
4001 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
4002 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004003 DerivedToBase = false;
4004 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004005 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004006 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4007 // Nothing to do.
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004008 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor45bb4832013-03-26 23:36:30 +00004009 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
4010 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004011 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004012 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4013 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4014 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
4015 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004016 else
4017 return Ref_Incompatible;
4018
4019 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
4020 // least).
4021
4022 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
4023 // for comparison.
4024 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
4025 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
4026 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
4027 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
4028
4029 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4030 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
4031 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
4032 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
4033 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
4034 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
4035 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004036 //
4037 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
4038 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
4039 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
4040 // space 2.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004041 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
4042 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
Douglas Gregorc9f019a2013-11-08 02:04:24 +00004043 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(T2Quals, T1Quals))
4044 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4045
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004046 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4047 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004048 }
4049
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004050 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004051 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004052 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004053 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
4054 else
4055 return Ref_Related;
4056}
4057
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004058/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004059/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4060static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004061FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4062 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4063 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4064 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004065 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4066 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4067 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4068
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00004069 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00004070 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
4071 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
4072 Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4073 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
4074 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004075 NamedDecl *D = *I;
4076 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4077 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4078 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4079
4080 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4081 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4082 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4083 if (ConvTemplate)
4084 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4085 else
4086 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4087
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004088 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004089 // explicit conversions, skip it.
4090 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4091 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004092
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004093 if (AllowRvalues) {
4094 bool DerivedToBase = false;
4095 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004096 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorb0e6c8a2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004097
4098 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4099 // functions that return lvalues.
4100 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4101 const ReferenceType *RefType
4102 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4103 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4104 continue;
4105 }
4106
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004107 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004108 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4109 DeclLoc,
4110 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4111 .getUnqualifiedType(),
4112 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004113 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004114 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004115 continue;
4116 } else {
4117 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4118 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4119 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4120
4121 const ReferenceType *RefType =
4122 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4123 if (!RefType ||
4124 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4125 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4126 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004127 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004128
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004129 if (ConvTemplate)
4130 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004131 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4132 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004133 else
4134 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004135 DeclType, CandidateSet,
4136 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004137 }
4138
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004139 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4140
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004141 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00004142 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004143 case OR_Success:
4144 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4145 //
4146 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4147 // applying a conversion function to the argument
4148 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4149 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4150 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4151 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4152 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4153 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4154 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4155 return false;
4156
4157 ICS.setUserDefined();
4158 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4159 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004160 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004161 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00004162 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004163 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4164 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4165 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4166 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4167 return true;
4168
4169 case OR_Ambiguous:
4170 ICS.setAmbiguous();
4171 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4172 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4173 if (Cand->Viable)
4174 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4175 return true;
4176
4177 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4178 case OR_Deleted:
4179 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4180 // conversion; continue with other checks.
4181 return false;
4182 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004183
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004184 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004185}
4186
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004187/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4188/// initialization.
4189static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004190TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004191 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4192 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00004193 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004194 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4195
4196 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4197 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4198 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4199
4200 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4201 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4202
4203 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4204 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4205 // type of the resulting function.
4206 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4207 DeclAccessPair Found;
4208 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4209 false, Found))
4210 T2 = Fn->getType();
4211 }
4212
4213 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4214 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4215 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004216 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004217 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004218 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004219 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004220 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004221 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004222
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004223
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004224 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004225 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4226 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4227
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004228 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004229 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004230 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4231 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4232 //
4233 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4234 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4235 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004236 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004237 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4238 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4239 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4240 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4241 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4242 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4243 ICS.setStandard();
4244 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004245 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4246 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4247 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004248 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4249 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4250 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4251 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4252 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4253 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4254 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004255 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4256 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4257 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004258 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004259 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00004260 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00004261 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004262
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004263 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4264 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4265 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4266 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004267 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004268 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004269
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004270 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4271 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4272 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4273 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4274 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4275 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4276 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4277 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004278 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004279 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004280 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4281 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4282 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004283 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004284 }
4285 }
4286
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004287 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4288 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004289 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004290 //
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004291 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4292 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4293 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4294 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4295 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4296 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4297 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004298 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4299 // go together.
Richard Smithce4f6082012-05-24 04:29:20 +00004300 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004301 return ICS;
4302
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004303 // -- If the initializer expression
4304 //
4305 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004306 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004307 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4308 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4309 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4310 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4311 ICS.setStandard();
4312 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004313 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004314 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4315 : ICK_Identity;
4316 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4317 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4318 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4319 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4320 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4321 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4322 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4323 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4324 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4325 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4326 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004327 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
Richard Smith2bf7fdb2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004328 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
Richard Smithb94afe12014-07-14 19:54:05 +00004329 !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004330 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4331 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004332 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004333 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004334 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00004335 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
Ismail Pazarbasi1121de32014-01-17 21:08:52 +00004336 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004337 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004338 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004339
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004340 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4341 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004342 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4343 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004344 // "cv3 T3",
4345 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004346 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004347 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004348 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004349 // class subobject).
4350 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004351 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004352 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4353 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4354 AllowExplicit)) {
4355 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4356 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4357 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4358 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004359 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004360 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4361 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4362
Douglas Gregor95273c32011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004363 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolabe468d92011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004364 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004365
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00004366 // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try.
4367 if (T1->isFunctionType())
4368 return ICS;
4369
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004370 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4371 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4372 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4373 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4374 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4375 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4376 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4377 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4378 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4379 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4380 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4381 // initialization fails.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004382 //
4383 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4384 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4385 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4386 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4387 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4388 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4389 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4390 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4391 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4392 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004393 }
4394
4395 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4396 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4397 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4398 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4399 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4400 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4401 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4402 return ICS;
4403
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004404 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4405 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4406 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4407 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4408 return ICS;
4409
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004410 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004411 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4412 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4413 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4414 // underlying type of the reference according to
4415 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4416 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4417 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4418 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4419 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004420 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4421 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004422 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004423 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004424 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4425 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004426
4427 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4428 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4429 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004430 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00004431 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004432 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004433 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004434 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004435 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00004436 const ReferenceType *LValRefType =
4437 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType()
4438 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4439
4440 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3:
4441 // Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a
4442 // standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...]
4443 // binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function
4444 // lvalue.
4445 // Note that the function case is not possible here.
4446 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) {
4447 // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding
4448 // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue
4449 // reference to an rvalue!
4450 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType);
4451 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorb0e6c8a2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004452 }
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00004453
Ismail Pazarbasi99afd962014-01-24 10:54:12 +00004454 ICS.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004455 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor3ec79102011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004456 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
Richard Smith19172c42014-07-14 02:28:44 +00004457 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4458 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType;
Douglas Gregor3ec79102011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004459 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4460 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004461 }
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004462
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004463 return ICS;
4464}
4465
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004466static ImplicitConversionSequence
4467TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4468 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4469 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004470 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4471 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004472
4473/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4474/// initializer list From.
4475static ImplicitConversionSequence
4476TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4477 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4478 bool InOverloadResolution,
4479 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4480 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4481 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4482 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4483
4484 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4485 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
4486
Sebastian Redl09edce02012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004487 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004488 // initialized from init lists.
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004489 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004490 return Result;
4491
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004492 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4493 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4494 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4495 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4496 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004497 bool toStdInitializerList = false;
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004498 QualType X;
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004499 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Richard Smith0db1ea52012-12-09 06:48:56 +00004500 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004501 else
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004502 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004503 if (!X.isNull()) {
4504 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4505 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4506 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4507 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4508 InOverloadResolution,
4509 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4510 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4511 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4512 Result = ICS;
4513 break;
4514 }
4515 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4516 if (Result.isBad() ||
4517 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4518 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4519 Result = ICS;
4520 }
Douglas Gregor0f5c1c02012-04-04 23:09:20 +00004521
4522 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4523 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4524 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4525 Result.setStandard();
4526 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4527 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4528 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4529 }
4530
Sebastian Redlaa6feaa2012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004531 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004532 return Result;
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004533 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004534
4535 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4536 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4537 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4538 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4539 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4540 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004541 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4542 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
Richard Smitha93f1022013-09-06 22:30:28 +00004543 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4544 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4545 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004546 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4547 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004548 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004549
4550 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4551 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4552 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4553 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004554 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004555 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4556 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4557 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4558 InitializedEntity Entity =
4559 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4560 /*Consumed=*/false);
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00004561 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004562 Result.setUserDefined();
4563 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4564 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4565 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4566 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4567
4568 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4569 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4570 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00004571 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004572 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004573 return Result;
4574 }
4575
4576 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4577 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004578 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4579 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4580 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4581 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4582
4583 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4584
4585 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4586 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4587 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4588 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4589
4590 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4591
4592 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4593 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4594 // type of the resulting function.
4595 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4596 DeclAccessPair Found;
4597 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4598 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4599 T2 = Fn->getType();
4600 }
4601
4602 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4603 bool dummy1 = false;
4604 bool dummy2 = false;
4605 bool dummy3 = false;
4606 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4607 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4608 dummy2, dummy3);
4609
Richard Smith4d2bbd72013-09-06 01:22:42 +00004610 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) {
Richard Smitha93f1022013-09-06 22:30:28 +00004611 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/From->getLocStart(),
4612 SuppressUserConversions,
4613 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Richard Smith4d2bbd72013-09-06 01:22:42 +00004614 }
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004615 }
4616
4617 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4618 // initializer list.
4619 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4620 InOverloadResolution,
4621 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4622 if (Result.isFailure())
4623 return Result;
4624 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4625 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4626
4627 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4628 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4629 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4630 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4631 Result.UserDefined.After;
4632 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4633 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4634 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4635 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4636 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4637 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4638 } else
4639 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4640 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004641 return Result;
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004642 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004643
4644 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4645 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4646 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4647 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4648 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4649 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004650 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4651 if (NumInits == 1)
4652 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4653 SuppressUserConversions,
4654 InOverloadResolution,
4655 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4656 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4657 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4658 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4659 Result.setStandard();
4660 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCallb73bc9a2012-04-04 02:40:27 +00004661 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4662 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004663 }
4664 return Result;
4665 }
4666
4667 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4668 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4669 return Result;
4670}
4671
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004672/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4673/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4674/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4675/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004676/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004677/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004678static ImplicitConversionSequence
4679TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004680 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004681 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004682 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4683 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004684 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4685 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4686 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4687
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004688 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004689 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004690 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4691 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004692 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004693
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004694 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4695 SuppressUserConversions,
4696 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004697 InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004698 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004699 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4700 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004701}
4702
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004703static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4704 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4705 Sema &S,
4706 SourceLocation Loc,
4707 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4708 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4709 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4710 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4711
4712 return !ICS.isBad();
4713}
4714
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004715/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4716/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4717/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004718static ImplicitConversionSequence
Richard Smith03c66d32013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004719TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004720 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004721 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4722 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4723 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004724 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4725 // const volatile object.
4726 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4727 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004728 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004729
4730 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4731 // to exit early.
4732 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004733
4734 // We need to have an object of class type.
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004735 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004736 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4737
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004738 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4739 // better have an lvalue.
4740 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4741 }
4742
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004743 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004744
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004745 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004746 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004747 // parameter is
4748 //
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004749 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4750 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4751 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004752 // ref-qualifier
4753 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004754 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004755 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4756 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004757 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004758 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004759 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4760 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4761 // non-constant references.
4762
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004763 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004764 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004765 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004766 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004767 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004768 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
Richard Smith03c66d32013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004769 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004770 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004771 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004772
4773 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4774 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004775 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004776 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4777 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4778 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004779 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004780 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004781 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004782 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4783 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004784 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004785 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004786
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004787 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4788 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4789 case RQ_None:
4790 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4791 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004792
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004793 case RQ_LValue:
4794 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4795 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004796 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004797 ImplicitParamType);
4798 return ICS;
4799 }
4800 break;
4801
4802 case RQ_RValue:
4803 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4804 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004805 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004806 ImplicitParamType);
4807 return ICS;
4808 }
4809 break;
4810 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004811
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004812 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004813 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004814 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4815 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004816 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004817 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004818 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4819 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004820 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004821 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004822 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4823 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4824 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004825 return ICS;
4826}
4827
4828/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4829/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4830/// expression.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004831ExprResult
4832Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004833 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004834 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004835 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004836 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004837 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004838 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004839
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004840 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004841 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004842 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4843 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004844 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004845 } else {
4846 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4847 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004848 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004849 }
4850
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004851 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4852 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004853 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004854 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4855 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004856 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4857 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4858 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4859 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4860 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4861 if (CVR) {
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004862 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004863 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4864 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4865 << From->getSourceRange();
4866 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4867 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004868 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004869 }
4870 }
4871
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004872 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004873 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004874 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004875 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004876
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004877 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4878 ExprResult FromRes =
4879 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4880 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4881 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +00004882 From = FromRes.get();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004883 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004884
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004885 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004886 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +00004887 From->getValueKind()).get();
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00004888 return From;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004889}
4890
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004891/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4892/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004893static ImplicitConversionSequence
4894TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004895 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004896 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004897 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004898 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004899 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004900 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4901 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004902}
4903
4904/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4905/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004906ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004907 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4908 return ExprError();
4909
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004910 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004911 if (!ICS.isBad())
4912 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004913
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004914 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004915 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004916 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004917 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004918 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004919}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004920
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004921/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4922/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4923/// is acceptable.
4924static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4925 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4926 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4927 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4928 // conversions are fine.
4929 switch (SCS.Second) {
4930 case ICK_Identity:
4931 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4932 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
Guy Benyei259f9f42013-02-07 16:05:33 +00004933 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004934 return true;
4935
4936 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
Richard Smithca24ed42012-09-13 22:00:12 +00004937 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4938 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4939 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4940 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4941 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4942
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004943 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4944 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4945 return false;
4946
4947 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4948 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4949 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4950 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4951 case ICK_Qualification:
4952 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4953 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4954 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4955 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4956 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4957 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4958 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4959 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4960 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4961 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4962 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4963 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4964 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4965 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4966
4967 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4968 break;
4969 }
4970
4971 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4972}
4973
4974/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4975/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4976/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4977ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4978 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4979 CCEKind CCE) {
Richard Smith2bf7fdb2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004980 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus11 && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004981 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4982
4983 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4984 return ExprError();
4985
4986 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4987 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4988 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4989 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4990 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4991 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4992 // narrowing conversions.
4993 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4994 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4995 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4996 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4997 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4998 /*CStyle=*/false,
4999 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005000 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005001 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5002 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5003 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005004 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005005 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5006 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5007 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
5008 break;
5009 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5010 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
5011 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
5012 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005013 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005014 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5015 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5016 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
5017 break;
5018 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5019 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5020 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005021 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005022 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
5023 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5024 return ExprError();
5025
5026 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5027 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
5028 }
5029
5030 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
5031 if (Result.isInvalid())
5032 return Result;
5033
5034 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
5035 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +00005036 QualType PreNarrowingType;
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +00005037 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
5038 PreNarrowingType)) {
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005039 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
5040 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
5041 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
5042 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
5043 break;
5044
5045 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
Richard Smith16e1b072013-11-12 02:41:45 +00005046 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005047 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
Richard Smith5614ca72012-03-23 23:55:39 +00005048 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005049 break;
5050
5051 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
Richard Smith16e1b072013-11-12 02:41:45 +00005052 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005053 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
5054 break;
5055 }
5056
5057 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005058 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005059 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5060 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5061
Douglas Gregorebe2db72013-04-08 23:24:07 +00005062 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context) || !Eval.Val.isInt()) {
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005063 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5064 // the AST.
5065 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005066 } else {
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005067 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005068
5069 if (Notes.empty()) {
5070 // It's a constant expression.
5071 return Result;
5072 }
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005073 }
5074
5075 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5076 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5077 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5078 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5079 else {
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005080 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005081 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5082 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5083 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5084 }
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005085 return Result;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005086}
5087
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005088/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5089/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
5090/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5091static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5092 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5093 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5094 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5095 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5096 }
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005097}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005098
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005099/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5100/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5101static ImplicitConversionSequence
5102TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5103 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5104 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5105 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5106 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5107 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5108 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5109 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5110 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5111 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005112 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5113 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true);
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005114
5115 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5116 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5117 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5118 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5119 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5120 break;
5121
5122 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5123 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5124 break;
5125
5126 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5127 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5128 break;
5129 }
5130
5131 return ICS;
5132}
5133
5134/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5135/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5136ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00005137 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5138 return ExprError();
5139
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005140 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005141 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5142 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005143 if (!ICS.isBad())
5144 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005145 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005146}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005147
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005148/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5149/// type of a permitted flavor.
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005150bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5151 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5152 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005153}
5154
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005155static ExprResult
5156diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5157 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5158 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5159
5160 if (Converter.Suppress)
5161 return ExprError();
5162
5163 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5164 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5165 CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5166 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5167 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5168 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5169 }
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00005170 return From;
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005171}
5172
5173static bool
5174diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5175 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5176 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5177 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5178 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5179 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5180 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5181 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5182
5183 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5184 // conversion; use it.
5185 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5186 std::string TypeStr;
5187 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5188
5189 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5190 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5191 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5192 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
Alp Tokerb6cc5922014-05-03 03:45:55 +00005193 SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), ")");
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005194 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5195
5196 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5197 // explicit conversion function.
5198 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5199 return true;
5200
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005201 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005202 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5203 HadMultipleCandidates);
5204 if (Result.isInvalid())
5205 return true;
5206 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5207 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005208 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5209 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind());
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005210 }
5211 return false;
5212}
5213
5214static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5215 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5216 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5217 DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5218 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5219 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005220 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005221
5222 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5223 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5224 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5225 return true;
5226
5227 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5228 << From->getSourceRange();
5229 }
5230
5231 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5232 HadMultipleCandidates);
5233 if (Result.isInvalid())
5234 return true;
5235 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5236 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005237 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5238 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind());
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005239 return false;
5240}
5241
5242static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5243 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5244 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5245 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5246 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5247 << From->getSourceRange();
5248
5249 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5250}
5251
5252static void
5253collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5254 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5255 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5256 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5257 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
5258 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5259 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
5260 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5261 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5262
5263 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
5264 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
5265 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
5266 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5267 else
5268 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5269
5270 if (ConvTemplate)
5271 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005272 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet,
5273 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005274 else
5275 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005276 ToType, CandidateSet,
5277 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005278 }
5279}
5280
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005281/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
5282/// by the given converter.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005283///
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005284/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
5285/// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
5286/// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
5287/// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
5288/// one target type.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005289///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005290/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5291/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005292///
James Dennett18348b62012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005293/// \param From The expression we're converting from.
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005294///
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005295/// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005296///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005297/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5298/// successful.
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005299ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
5300 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005301 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5302 if (From->isTypeDependent())
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00005303 return From;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005304
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005305 // Process placeholders immediately.
5306 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5307 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005308 if (result.isInvalid())
5309 return result;
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +00005310 From = result.get();
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005311 }
5312
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005313 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005314 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005315 if (Converter.match(T))
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005316 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005317
5318 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5319
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005320 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
5321 // type.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005322 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005323 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005324 if (!Converter.Suppress)
5325 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00005326 return From;
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005327 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005328
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005329 // We must have a complete class type.
Douglas Gregora6c5abb2012-05-04 16:48:41 +00005330 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005331 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
Douglas Gregore2b37442012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005332 Expr *From;
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005333
5334 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
5335 : TypeDiagnoser(Converter.Suppress), Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
5336
Craig Toppere14c0f82014-03-12 04:55:44 +00005337 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005338 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005339 }
Richard Smithccc11812013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005340 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005341
5342 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +00005343 return From;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005344
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005345 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005346 UnresolvedSet<4>
5347 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005348 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005349 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005350 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions =
5351 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005352
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005353 bool HadMultipleCandidates =
5354 (std::distance(Conversions.first, Conversions.second) > 1);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005355
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005356 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
5357 QualType ToType;
5358 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
5359
5360 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
5361 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator I = Conversions.first,
5362 E = Conversions.second;
5363 I != E; ++I) {
5364 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
5365 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
5366 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
5367 if (ConvTemplate) {
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00005368 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14)
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005369 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5370 else
5371 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
5372 } else
5373 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5374
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00005375 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) &&
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005376 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
5377 "viable in C++1y");
5378
5379 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5380 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
5381
5382 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
5383 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
5384 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
5385 if (!ConvTemplate)
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005386 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005387 } else {
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00005388 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005389 if (ToType.isNull())
5390 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
5391 else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
5392 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
5393 HasUniqueTargetType = false;
5394 }
5395 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005396 }
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005397 }
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005398 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005399
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00005400 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005401 // C++1y [conv]p6:
5402 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
5403 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
5404 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
5405 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
Larisse Voufo67170bd2013-06-10 08:25:58 +00005406 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
5407 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005408 // exactly one such T.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005409
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005410 // If no unique T is found:
5411 if (ToType.isNull()) {
5412 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5413 HadMultipleCandidates,
5414 ExplicitConversions))
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005415 return ExprError();
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005416 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005417 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005418
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005419 // If more than one unique Ts are found:
5420 if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
5421 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5422 ViableConversions);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005423
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005424 // If one unique T is found:
5425 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
5426 // potentially viable conversions.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00005427 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005428 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
5429 CandidateSet);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005430
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005431 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
5432 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
5433 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
5434 case OR_Success: {
5435 // Apply this conversion.
5436 DeclAccessPair Found =
5437 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
5438 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5439 HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5440 return ExprError();
5441 break;
5442 }
5443 case OR_Ambiguous:
5444 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5445 ViableConversions);
5446 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
5447 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5448 HadMultipleCandidates,
5449 ExplicitConversions))
5450 return ExprError();
5451 // fall through 'OR_Deleted' case.
5452 case OR_Deleted:
5453 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5454 break;
5455 }
5456 } else {
5457 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5458 case 0: {
5459 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5460 HadMultipleCandidates,
5461 ExplicitConversions))
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005462 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005463
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005464 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5465 break;
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005466 }
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005467 case 1: {
5468 // Apply this conversion.
5469 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5470 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5471 HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5472 return ExprError();
5473 break;
5474 }
5475 default:
5476 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5477 ViableConversions);
5478 }
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005479 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005480
Larisse Voufo236bec22013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005481 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005482}
5483
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00005484/// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is
5485/// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose
5486/// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine
5487/// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning
5488/// enumeration types.
5489static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context,
5490 FunctionDecl *Fn,
5491 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
5492 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
5493 QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType();
5494
5495 if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType()))
5496 return true;
5497
5498 if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType()))
5499 return true;
5500
5501 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
5502 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1)
5503 return false;
5504
5505 if (T1->isEnumeralType()) {
5506 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType();
5507 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType))
5508 return true;
5509 }
5510
5511 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2)
5512 return false;
5513
5514 if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) {
5515 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType();
5516 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType))
5517 return true;
5518 }
5519
5520 return false;
5521}
5522
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005523/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005524/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5525/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5526/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005527///
James Dennett2a4d13c2012-06-15 07:13:21 +00005528/// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005529/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5530/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005531void
5532Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005533 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005534 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005535 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005536 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005537 bool PartialOverloading,
5538 bool AllowExplicit) {
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005539 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005540 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005541 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005542 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005543 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005544
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005545 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005546 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5547 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5548 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5549 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5550 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005551 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5552 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5553 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005554 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005555 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005556 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005557 return;
5558 }
5559 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5560 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005561 }
5562
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005563 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005564 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005565
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00005566 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5567 // if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the
5568 // lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to
5569 // (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there
5570 // is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to
5571 // (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are
5572 // candidate functions.
5573 if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
5574 !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args))
5575 return;
5576
Richard Smith8b86f2d2013-11-04 01:48:18 +00005577 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402]
5578 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by
5579 // overload resolution.
5580 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function);
5581 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() &&
5582 Constructor->isMoveConstructor())
5583 return;
5584
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005585 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005586 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005587
Richard Smith8b86f2d2013-11-04 01:48:18 +00005588 if (Constructor) {
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005589 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5590 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5591 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5592 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005593 if (Args.size() == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005594 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005595 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5596 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005597 return;
5598 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005599
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005600 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005601 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005602 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005603 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005604 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005605 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005606 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005607 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005608
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005609 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005610
5611 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5612 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5613 // list (8.3.5).
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005614 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumParams &&
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005615 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005616 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005617 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005618 return;
5619 }
5620
5621 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5622 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5623 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5624 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5625 // exactly m parameters.
5626 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005627 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005628 // Not enough arguments.
5629 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005630 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005631 return;
5632 }
5633
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005634 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005635 if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005636 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5637 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5638 Candidate.Viable = false;
5639 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5640 return;
5641 }
5642
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005643 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5644 // arguments.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005645 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005646 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005647 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5648 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5649 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5650 // parameter of F.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00005651 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005652 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005653 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005654 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005655 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5656 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005657 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005658 AllowExplicit);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005659 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5660 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005661 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005662 return;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005663 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005664 } else {
5665 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5666 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5667 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005668 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005669 }
5670 }
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005671
5672 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Function, Args)) {
5673 Candidate.Viable = false;
5674 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
5675 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
5676 return;
5677 }
5678}
5679
Fariborz Jahanian30ae8d42014-08-13 21:07:35 +00005680ObjCMethodDecl *Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args,
Fariborz Jahanian0ded4242014-08-13 21:24:14 +00005681 bool IsInstance) {
5682 SmallVector<ObjCMethodDecl*, 4> Methods;
5683 if (!CollectMultipleMethodsInGlobalPool(Sel, Methods, IsInstance))
5684 return nullptr;
5685
Fariborz Jahanian30ae8d42014-08-13 21:07:35 +00005686 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
5687 bool Match = true;
5688 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b];
5689 unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs();
5690 // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due
5691 // to addition of c-style arguments in method.
5692 if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs)
5693 NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size();
5694 if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs)
5695 continue;
5696
5697 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) {
5698 // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument.
5699 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
5700 Match = false;
5701 break;
5702 }
5703
5704 ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i];
5705 Expr *argExpr = Args[i];
5706 assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression");
5707
5708 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's
5709 // a consumed argument.
5710 if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) &&
5711 !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())
5712 argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr);
5713
5714 // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method.
5715 if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
5716 Match = false;
5717 break;
5718 }
5719
5720 ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState
5721 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(),
5722 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false,
5723 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5724 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5725 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
5726 /*AllowExplicit*/false);
5727 if (ConversionState.isBad()) {
5728 Match = false;
5729 break;
5730 }
5731 }
5732 // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods.
5733 if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) {
5734 for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) {
5735 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
5736 Match = false;
5737 break;
5738 }
5739 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
5740 nullptr);
5741 if (Arg.isInvalid()) {
5742 Match = false;
5743 break;
5744 }
5745 }
Fariborz Jahanian180d76b2014-08-27 16:38:47 +00005746 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian30ae8d42014-08-13 21:07:35 +00005747 // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods.
5748 if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs)
5749 Match = false;
Fariborz Jahanian180d76b2014-08-27 16:38:47 +00005750 else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) {
5751 // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select
5752 // one with the most general result type of 'id'.
5753 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
5754 QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType();
5755 if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType())
5756 return Methods[b];
5757 }
5758 }
5759 }
Fariborz Jahanian30ae8d42014-08-13 21:07:35 +00005760
5761 if (Match)
5762 return Method;
5763 }
5764 return nullptr;
5765}
5766
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005767static bool IsNotEnableIfAttr(Attr *A) { return !isa<EnableIfAttr>(A); }
5768
5769EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5770 bool MissingImplicitThis) {
5771 // FIXME: specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> iterates in reverse order, but
5772 // we need to find the first failing one.
5773 if (!Function->hasAttrs())
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005774 return nullptr;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005775 AttrVec Attrs = Function->getAttrs();
5776 AttrVec::iterator E = std::remove_if(Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(),
5777 IsNotEnableIfAttr);
5778 if (Attrs.begin() == E)
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005779 return nullptr;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005780 std::reverse(Attrs.begin(), E);
5781
5782 SFINAETrap Trap(*this);
5783
5784 // Convert the arguments.
5785 SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs;
5786 bool InitializationFailed = false;
5787 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5788 if (i == 0 && !MissingImplicitThis && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Function) &&
Nick Lewyckyb8336b72014-02-28 05:26:13 +00005789 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)->isStatic() &&
5790 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)) {
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005791 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function);
5792 ExprResult R =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005793 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005794 Method, Method);
5795 if (R.isInvalid()) {
5796 InitializationFailed = true;
5797 break;
5798 }
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +00005799 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005800 } else {
5801 ExprResult R =
5802 PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
5803 Context,
5804 Function->getParamDecl(i)),
5805 SourceLocation(),
5806 Args[i]);
5807 if (R.isInvalid()) {
5808 InitializationFailed = true;
5809 break;
5810 }
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +00005811 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005812 }
5813 }
5814
5815 if (InitializationFailed || Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
5816 return cast<EnableIfAttr>(Attrs[0]);
5817
5818 for (AttrVec::iterator I = Attrs.begin(); I != E; ++I) {
5819 APValue Result;
5820 EnableIfAttr *EIA = cast<EnableIfAttr>(*I);
5821 if (!EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
Craig Topperf78d8492014-08-29 06:05:01 +00005822 Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs)) ||
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005823 !Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) {
5824 return EIA;
5825 }
5826 }
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005827 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005828}
5829
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005830/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
Nick Lewyckyed4265c2013-09-22 10:06:01 +00005831/// the overload candidate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005832void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005833 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005834 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005835 bool SuppressUserConversions,
5836 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005837 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005838 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5839 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005840 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005841 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005842 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005843 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005844 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5845 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005846 else
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005847 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005848 SuppressUserConversions);
5849 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005850 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005851 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5852 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005853 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005854 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005855 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005856 Args[0]->getType(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005857 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5858 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005859 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005860 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005861 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005862 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005863 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005864 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005865}
5866
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005867/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5868/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005869void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005870 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005871 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola51629df2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005872 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005873 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005874 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005875 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005876 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005877
5878 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5879 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005880
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005881 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5882 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5883 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005884 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00005885 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005886 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola51629df2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005887 Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005888 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005889 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005890 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005891 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola51629df2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005892 Args,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005893 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005894 }
5895}
5896
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005897/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5898/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5899/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5900/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5901/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5902/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005903/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005904void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005905Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005906 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005907 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005908 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005909 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005910 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005911 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005912 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005913 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005914 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5915 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005916
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005917 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5918 return;
5919
Richard Smith8b86f2d2013-11-04 01:48:18 +00005920 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402]
5921 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is
5922 // ignored by overload resolution.
5923 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() &&
5924 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
5925 return;
5926
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005927 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005928 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005929
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005930 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005931 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005932 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005933 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005934 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005935 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005936 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005937
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005938 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005939
5940 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5941 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5942 // list (8.3.5).
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005943 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005944 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005945 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005946 return;
5947 }
5948
5949 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5950 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5951 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5952 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5953 // exactly m parameters.
5954 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005955 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005956 // Not enough arguments.
5957 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005958 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005959 return;
5960 }
5961
5962 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005963
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005964 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005965 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5966 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5967 else {
5968 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5969 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005970 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005971 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5972 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005973 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005974 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005975 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005976 return;
5977 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005978 }
5979
5980 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5981 // arguments.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005982 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00005983 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005984 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5985 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5986 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5987 // parameter of F.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00005988 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005989 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005990 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005991 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005992 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5993 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005994 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005995 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005996 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005997 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00005998 return;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005999 }
6000 } else {
6001 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6002 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006003 // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006004 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006005 }
6006 }
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006007
6008 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) {
6009 Candidate.Viable = false;
6010 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6011 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6012 return;
6013 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006014}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006015
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006016/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
6017/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
6018/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006019void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006020Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006021 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006022 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00006023 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006024 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006025 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00006026 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006027 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00006028 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006029 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
6030 return;
6031
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006032 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006033 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006034 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006035 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006036 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
6037 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
6038 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
6039 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
6040 // functions.
Craig Toppere6706e42012-09-19 02:26:47 +00006041 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00006042 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006043 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006044 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
6045 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006046 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006047 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6048 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
6049 Candidate.Viable = false;
6050 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6051 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6052 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006053 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006054 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006055 Info);
6056 return;
6057 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006058
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006059 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
6060 // deduction as a candidate.
6061 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006062 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006063 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006064 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006065 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
6066 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00006067}
6068
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006069/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
6070/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
6071/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006072void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006073Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006074 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00006075 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00006076 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006077 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00006078 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006079 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
6080 return;
6081
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006082 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006083 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006084 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006085 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006086 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
6087 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
6088 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
6089 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
6090 // functions.
Craig Toppere6706e42012-09-19 02:26:47 +00006091 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00006092 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006093 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006094 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
6095 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006096 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006097 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006098 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6099 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006100 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006101 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6102 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006103 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006104 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006105 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006106 return;
6107 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006108
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006109 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
6110 // deduction as a candidate.
6111 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006112 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00006113 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00006114}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006115
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006116/// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result
6117/// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++
6118/// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1.
6119///
6120/// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function.
6121///
6122/// \param ToType The type we are converting to.
6123///
6124/// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one
6125/// Objective-C pointer to another.
6126///
6127/// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise.
6128static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S,
6129 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType,
6130 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) {
6131 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
6132
6133 // Easy case: the types are the same.
6134 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType))
6135 return true;
6136
6137 // Allow qualification conversions.
6138 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
6139 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false,
6140 ObjCLifetimeConversion))
6141 return true;
6142
6143 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions,
6144 // we're done.
6145 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion)
6146 return false;
6147
6148 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion?
6149 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
6150 QualType ConvertedType;
6151 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType,
6152 IncompatibleObjC);
6153}
6154
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006155/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006156/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006157/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006158/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006159/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
6160/// conversion function produces).
6161void
6162Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006163 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006164 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006165 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006166 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6167 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006168 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
6169 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00006170 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006171 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6172 return;
6173
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00006174 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
6175 // deduction now.
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00006176 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00006177 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
6178 return;
6179 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6180 }
6181
Richard Smith089c3162013-09-21 21:55:46 +00006182 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion
6183 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or
6184 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006185 if (Conversion->isExplicit() &&
6186 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType,
6187 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit))
Richard Smith089c3162013-09-21 21:55:46 +00006188 return;
6189
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006190 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006191 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006192
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006193 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006194 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006195 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006196 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006197 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006198 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006199 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00006200 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00006201 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006202 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006203 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00006204
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00006205 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006206 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
6207 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00006208 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00006209 //
6210 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6211 // object parameter.
6212 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
6213 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
6214 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
6215 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
6216 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006217
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00006218 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006219 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
6220 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006221 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006222
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006223 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006224 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006225 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006226 return;
6227 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00006228
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006229 // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00006230 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
6231 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
6232 QualType FromCanon
6233 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
6234 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
6235 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
6236 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006237 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00006238 return;
6239 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006240
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006241 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
6242 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
6243 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
6244 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
6245 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
6246 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
6247 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
6248 // well-formed.
John McCall113bee02012-03-10 09:33:50 +00006249 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00006250 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00006251 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
6252 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006253 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00006254 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006255
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00006256 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
6257 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00006258 Candidate.Viable = false;
6259 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6260 return;
6261 }
6262
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00006263 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00006264
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006265 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00006266 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
6267 // allocator).
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00006268 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Dmitri Gribenko78852e92013-05-05 20:40:26 +00006269 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, None, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00006270 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006271 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006272 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006273 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006274 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6275 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006276
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006277 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006278 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
6279 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006280
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006281 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
6282 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006283 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006284 // shall have exact match rank.
6285 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
6286 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
6287 Candidate.Viable = false;
6288 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006289 return;
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006290 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006291
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00006292 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
6293 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
6294 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
6295 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
6296 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006297 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00006298 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
6299 Candidate.Viable = false;
6300 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006301 return;
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00006302 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006303 break;
6304
6305 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
6306 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006307 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006308 return;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006309
6310 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006311 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006312 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
6313 }
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006314
Craig Topper5fc8fc22014-08-27 06:28:36 +00006315 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) {
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006316 Candidate.Viable = false;
6317 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6318 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6319 return;
6320 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006321}
6322
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006323/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
6324/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
6325/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
6326/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
6327/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006328void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006329Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006330 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006331 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006332 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006333 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6334 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006335 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6336 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
6337
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006338 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
6339 return;
6340
Craig Toppere6706e42012-09-19 02:26:47 +00006341 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00006342 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006343 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006344 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006345 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006346 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006347 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6348 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6349 Candidate.Viable = false;
6350 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6351 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6352 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006353 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006354 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006355 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006356 return;
6357 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006358
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006359 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
6360 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
6361 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006362 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor4b60a152013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006363 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006364}
6365
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006366/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
6367/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
6368/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
6369/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
6370/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
6371void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006372 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006373 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006374 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006375 Expr *Object,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00006376 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006377 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006378 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6379 return;
6380
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006381 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006382 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006383
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006384 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006385 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00006386 Candidate.Function = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006387 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
6388 Candidate.Viable = true;
6389 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006390 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006391 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006392
6393 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6394 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006395 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006396 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006397 Object->Classify(Context),
6398 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006399 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006400 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006401 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006402 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006403 return;
6404 }
6405
6406 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
6407 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
6408 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006409 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006410 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00006411 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00006412 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006413 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00006414 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006415 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006416 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
6417 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
6418
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006419 // Find the
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00006420 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006421
6422 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6423 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6424 // list (8.3.5).
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00006425 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006426 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006427 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006428 return;
6429 }
6430
6431 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
6432 // we have enough arguments.
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00006433 if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006434 // Not enough arguments.
6435 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006436 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006437 return;
6438 }
6439
6440 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6441 // arguments.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006442 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00006443 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006444 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6445 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6446 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6447 // parameter of F.
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006448 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006449 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006450 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006451 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006452 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6453 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006454 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006455 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006456 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006457 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006458 return;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006459 }
6460 } else {
6461 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6462 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6463 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006464 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006465 }
6466 }
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006467
Craig Topper5fc8fc22014-08-27 06:28:36 +00006468 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) {
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00006469 Candidate.Viable = false;
6470 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6471 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6472 return;
6473 }
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006474}
6475
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006476/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
6477/// member functions.
6478///
6479/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
6480/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
6481/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
6482/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
6483/// [over.match.oper]).
6484void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6485 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006486 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006487 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6488 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006489 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
6490
6491 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6492 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
6493 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
6494 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
6495 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
6496 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
6497 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
6498 // constructed as follows:
6499 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006500
Richard Smith0feaf0c2013-04-20 12:41:22 +00006501 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
6502 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
6503 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
6504 // the set of member candidates is empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006505 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Richard Smith0feaf0c2013-04-20 12:41:22 +00006506 // Complete the type if it can be completed.
6507 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0);
6508 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
6509 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006510 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006511
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006512 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
6513 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
6514 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
6515
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006516 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006517 OperEnd = Operators.end();
6518 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006519 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006520 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
Rafael Espindola51629df2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00006521 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006522 Args.slice(1),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006523 CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006524 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006525 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006526}
6527
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006528/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
6529/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
6530/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006531/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
6532/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006533/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
6534/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
6535/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006536void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006537 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006538 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006539 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
6540 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006541 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006542 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006543
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006544 // Add this candidate
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006545 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00006546 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none);
6547 Candidate.Function = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00006548 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006549 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006550 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006551 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006552 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
6553
6554 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6555 // arguments.
6556 Candidate.Viable = true;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006557 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6558 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006559 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
6560 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
6561 // left operand are restricted as follows:
6562 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
6563 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
6564 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006565 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006566 //
6567 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6568 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6569 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6570 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006571 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006572 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006573 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006574 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6575 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006576 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006577 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006578 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006579 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006580 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6581 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006582 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006583 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006584 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006585 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006586 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006587 break;
6588 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006589 }
6590}
6591
Craig Toppercd7b0332013-07-01 06:29:40 +00006592namespace {
6593
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006594/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6595/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6596/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6597/// enumeration types.
6598class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
6599 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006600 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006601
6602 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6603 /// built-in candidates.
6604 TypeSet PointerTypes;
6605
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006606 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6607 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6608 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6609
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006610 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6611 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6612 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6613
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006614 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006615 /// candidates.
6616 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006617
6618 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6619 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6620
6621 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6622 /// were present in the candidate set.
6623 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6624
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006625 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6626 /// candidate set.
6627 bool HasNullPtrType;
6628
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00006629 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6630 /// candidate type set.
6631 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006632
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006633 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6634 ASTContext &Context;
6635
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006636 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6637 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006638 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006639
6640public:
6641 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006642 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006643
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006644 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006645 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6646 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006647 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006648 SemaRef(SemaRef),
6649 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006650
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006651 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006652 SourceLocation Loc,
6653 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006654 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6655 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006656
6657 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6658 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6659
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006660 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006661 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6662
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006663 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6664 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6665
6666 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6667 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6668
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006669 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6670 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6671
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006672 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006673 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006674
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006675 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6676 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006677
6678 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6679 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006680 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006681};
6682
Craig Toppercd7b0332013-07-01 06:29:40 +00006683} // end anonymous namespace
6684
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006685/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006686/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6687/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6688/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6689/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6690/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6691/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006692///
6693/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006694bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006695BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6696 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006697
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006698 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006699 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006700 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006701
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006702 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006703 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006704 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006705 if (!PointerTy) {
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006706 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6707 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6708 buildObjCPtr = true;
6709 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006710 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006711 }
6712
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006713 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6714 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6715 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6716 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6717 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6718 return true;
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006719
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006720 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006721 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6722 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006723
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006724 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6725 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6726 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006727 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006728 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006729
6730 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6731 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6732 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6733 (!hasRestrict ||
6734 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6735 continue;
6736
6737 // Build qualified pointee type.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006738 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006739
6740 // Build qualified pointer type.
6741 QualType QPointerTy;
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006742 if (!buildObjCPtr)
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006743 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006744 else
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006745 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6746
6747 // Insert qualified pointer type.
6748 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006749 }
6750
6751 return true;
6752}
6753
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006754/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6755/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6756/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6757/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6758/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6759/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6760/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006761///
6762/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006763bool
6764BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6765 QualType Ty) {
6766 // Insert this type.
6767 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6768 return false;
6769
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006770 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6771 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006772
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006773 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006774 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6775 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6776 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6777 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6778 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6779 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006780 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6781
6782 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6783 // qualifiers.
6784 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6785 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6786 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006787
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006788 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006789 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6790 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006791 }
6792
6793 return true;
6794}
6795
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006796/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6797/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006798/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6799/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006800/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6801/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6802/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6803/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006804void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006805BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006806 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006807 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006808 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6809 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006810 // Only deal with canonical types.
6811 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6812
6813 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6814 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006815 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006816 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6817
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006818 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6819 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6820 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6821
6822 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006823 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006824
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006825 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6826 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6827 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6828
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006829 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6830 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6831 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6832
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006833 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6834 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6835 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006836 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6837 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006838 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006839 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006840 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6841 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6842 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6843 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006844 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006845 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006846 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006847 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006848 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6849 // extension.
6850 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006851 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006852 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6853 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006854 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6855 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6856 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6857 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006858
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006859 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006860 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6861 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6862 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6863 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6864 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006865 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6866 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6867 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006868
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006869 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6870 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6871 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6872 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006873
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006874 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6875 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6876 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6877 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006878 }
6879 }
6880 }
6881}
6882
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006883/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6884/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6885/// given type to the candidate set.
6886static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6887 QualType T,
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006888 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006889 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6890 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006891
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006892 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6893 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6894 ParamTypes[1] = T;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006895 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006896 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006897
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006898 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6899 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006900 ParamTypes[0]
6901 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006902 ParamTypes[1] = T;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006903 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006904 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006905 }
6906}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006907
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006908/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6909/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006910static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6911 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6912 const RecordType *TyRec;
6913 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6914 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006915 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006916 else
6917 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6918 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006919 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006920 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6921 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6922 return VRQuals;
6923 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006924
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006925 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006926 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6927 return VRQuals;
6928
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006929 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6930 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6931 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006932
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006933 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6934 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006935 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6936 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6937 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6938 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006939 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6940 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6941 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6942 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6943 // as see them.
6944 bool done = false;
6945 while (!done) {
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006946 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6947 VRQuals.addRestrict();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006948 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6949 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006950 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006951 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6952 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6953 else
6954 done = true;
6955 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6956 VRQuals.addVolatile();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006957 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6958 return VRQuals;
6959 }
6960 }
6961 }
6962 return VRQuals;
6963}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006964
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006965namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006966
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006967/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6968/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6969/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6970/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6971class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006972 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6973 Sema &S;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006974 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006975 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006976 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006977 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006978 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006979
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006980 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6981 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006982 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6983 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006984 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006985 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006986 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006987 LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006988 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006989 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
6990 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006991
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006992 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6993 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6994 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6995 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6996 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6997 // Start of promoted types.
6998 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6999 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
7000 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00007001
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007002 // Start of integral types.
7003 &ASTContext::IntTy,
7004 &ASTContext::LongTy,
7005 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007006 &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007007 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
7008 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
7009 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007010 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007011 // End of promoted types.
7012
7013 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
7014 &ASTContext::CharTy,
7015 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
7016 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
7017 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
7018 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
7019 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
7020 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
7021 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
7022 // End of integral types.
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007023 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007024 };
7025 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
7026 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007027
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007028 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
7029 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
7030 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
7031 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
7032 // The rules are basically:
7033 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
7034 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
7035 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
7036 // - use the larger type
7037 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
7038 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
7039 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
7040 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
7041 // better not to make any assumptions).
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007042 // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007043 enum PromotedType {
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007044 Dep=-1,
7045 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007046 };
Nuno Lopes9af6b032012-04-21 14:45:25 +00007047 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007048 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007049/* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
7050/* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
7051/*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
7052/* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
7053/* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, S128, Dep, UL, ULL, U128 },
7054/* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, S128, Dep, Dep, ULL, U128 },
7055/*S128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
7056/* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
7057/* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, S128, UL, UL, ULL, U128 },
7058/* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, S128, ULL, ULL, ULL, U128 },
7059/*U128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007060 };
7061
7062 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
7063 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
7064 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
7065
7066 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007067 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007068
7069 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
7070 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007071 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
7072 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007073 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
7074 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
7075
7076 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
7077 if (LW > RW) return LT;
7078 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
7079
7080 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
7081 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
7082 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
7083 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
7084 }
7085
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00007086 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
7087 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007088 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007089 bool HasVolatile,
7090 bool HasRestrict) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007091 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7092 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
7093 S.Context.IntTy
7094 };
7095
7096 // Non-volatile version.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007097 if (Args.size() == 1)
7098 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007099 else
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007100 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007101
7102 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
7103 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
7104 if (HasVolatile) {
7105 ParamTypes[0] =
7106 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7107 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007108 if (Args.size() == 1)
7109 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007110 else
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007111 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007112 }
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007113
7114 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
7115 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
7116 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
7117 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
7118 ParamTypes[0]
7119 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7120 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007121 if (Args.size() == 1)
7122 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007123 else
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007124 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007125
7126 if (HasVolatile) {
7127 ParamTypes[0]
7128 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7129 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
7130 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7131 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007132 if (Args.size() == 1)
7133 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007134 else
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007135 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007136 }
7137 }
7138
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007139 }
7140
7141public:
7142 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007143 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007144 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007145 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007146 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007147 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007148 : S(S), Args(Args),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007149 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007150 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
7151 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007152 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
7153 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
7154 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007155 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007156 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007157 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007158 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007159 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007160 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
7161 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007162 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007163 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
Richard Smith521ecc12012-06-10 08:00:26 +00007164 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007165 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
7166 }
7167
7168 // C++ [over.built]p3:
7169 //
7170 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
7171 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
7172 // functions of the form
7173 //
7174 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
7175 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
7176 //
7177 // C++ [over.built]p4:
7178 //
7179 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
7180 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
7181 // candidate operator functions of the form
7182 //
7183 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
7184 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
7185 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007186 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7187 return;
7188
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007189 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
7190 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
7191 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007192 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007193 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
7194 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007195 }
7196 }
7197
7198 // C++ [over.built]p5:
7199 //
7200 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7201 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
7202 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7203 //
7204 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
7205 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
7206 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
7207 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
7208 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
7209 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7210 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7211 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7212 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7213 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007214 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007215 continue;
7216
7217 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007218 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7219 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
7220 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7221 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007222 }
7223 }
7224
7225 // C++ [over.built]p6:
7226 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
7227 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7228 //
7229 // T& operator*(T*);
7230 //
7231 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007232 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00007233 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007234 // T& operator*(T*);
7235 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
7236 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7237 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7238 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7239 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7240 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
7241 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007242 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
7243 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007244
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00007245 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
7246 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
7247 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007248
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007249 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007250 &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007251 }
7252 }
7253
7254 // C++ [over.built]p9:
7255 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
7256 // operator functions of the form
7257 //
7258 // T operator+(T);
7259 // T operator-(T);
7260 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007261 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7262 return;
7263
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007264 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7265 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007266 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007267 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007268 }
7269
7270 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
7271 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7272 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7273 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7274 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7275 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007276 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007277 }
7278 }
7279
7280 // C++ [over.built]p8:
7281 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
7282 // the form
7283 //
7284 // T* operator+(T*);
7285 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
7286 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7287 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7288 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7289 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7290 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007291 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007292 }
7293 }
7294
7295 // C++ [over.built]p10:
7296 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
7297 // operator functions of the form
7298 //
7299 // T operator~(T);
7300 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007301 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7302 return;
7303
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007304 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7305 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007306 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007307 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007308 }
7309
7310 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
7311 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7312 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7313 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7314 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7315 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007316 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007317 }
7318 }
7319
7320 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
7321 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
7322 // functions of the form
7323 //
7324 // bool operator==(T,T);
7325 // bool operator!=(T,T);
7326 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
7327 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7328 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7329
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007330 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007331 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7332 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7333 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7334 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
7335 ++MemPtr) {
7336 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7337 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7338 continue;
7339
7340 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007341 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007342 }
7343 }
7344 }
7345
7346 // C++ [over.built]p15:
7347 //
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007348 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
7349 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007350 //
7351 // bool operator<(T, T);
7352 // bool operator>(T, T);
7353 // bool operator<=(T, T);
7354 // bool operator>=(T, T);
7355 // bool operator==(T, T);
7356 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007357 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
Eli Friedman14f082b2012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007358 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7359 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
7360 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
7361 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
7362 // candidate.
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007363 //
Eli Friedman14f082b2012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007364 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
7365 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
7366 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
7367 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007368 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
7369 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
7370 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
7371 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
7372
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007373 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007374 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
7375 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
7376 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
7377 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7378 C != CEnd; ++C) {
7379 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
7380 continue;
7381
Eli Friedman14f082b2012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007382 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
7383 continue;
7384
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007385 QualType FirstParamType =
7386 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7387 QualType SecondParamType =
7388 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7389
7390 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
7391 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
7392 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
7393 continue;
7394
7395 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
7396 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
7397 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
7398 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
7399 }
7400 }
7401 }
7402
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007403 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7404 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7405
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007406 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007407 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7408 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7409 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7410 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7411 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7412 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7413 continue;
7414
7415 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007416 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007417 }
7418 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7419 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7420 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7421 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7422 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
7423
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007424 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
7425 // candidate exists.
7426 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
7427 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
7428 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007429 continue;
7430
7431 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007432 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007433 }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007434
7435 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
7436 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
7437 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007438 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007439 NullPtrTy))) {
7440 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007441 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args,
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007442 CandidateSet);
7443 }
7444 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007445 }
7446 }
7447
7448 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7449 //
7450 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
7451 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7452 //
7453 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7454 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
7455 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7456 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
7457 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
7458 //
7459 // C++ [over.built]p14:
7460 //
7461 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
7462 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7463 //
7464 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7465 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7466 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7467 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7468
7469 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
7470 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
7471 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7472 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7473 };
7474 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7475 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
7476 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
7477 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007478 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
7479 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
7480 continue;
7481
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007482 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
7483 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
7484 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
7485 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007486 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007487 }
7488 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
7489 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7490 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7491 continue;
7492
7493 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7494 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007495 Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007496 }
7497 }
7498 }
7499 }
7500
7501 // C++ [over.built]p12:
7502 //
7503 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
7504 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7505 //
7506 // LR operator*(L, R);
7507 // LR operator/(L, R);
7508 // LR operator+(L, R);
7509 // LR operator-(L, R);
7510 // bool operator<(L, R);
7511 // bool operator>(L, R);
7512 // bool operator<=(L, R);
7513 // bool operator>=(L, R);
7514 // bool operator==(L, R);
7515 // bool operator!=(L, R);
7516 //
7517 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7518 // between types L and R.
7519 //
7520 // C++ [over.built]p24:
7521 //
7522 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
7523 // candidate operator functions of the form
7524 //
7525 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
7526 //
7527 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7528 // between types L and R.
7529 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
7530 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007531 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7532 return;
7533
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007534 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7535 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
7536 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7537 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007538 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7539 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007540 QualType Result =
7541 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007542 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007543 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007544 }
7545 }
7546
7547 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
7548 // conditional operator for vector types.
7549 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7550 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7551 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7552 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7553 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7554 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7555 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7556 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7557 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
7558 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
7559 if (!isComparison) {
7560 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
7561 Result = *Vec1;
7562 else
7563 Result = *Vec2;
7564 }
7565
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007566 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007567 }
7568 }
7569 }
7570
7571 // C++ [over.built]p17:
7572 //
7573 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7574 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7575 //
7576 // LR operator%(L, R);
7577 // LR operator&(L, R);
7578 // LR operator^(L, R);
7579 // LR operator|(L, R);
7580 // L operator<<(L, R);
7581 // L operator>>(L, R);
7582 //
7583 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7584 // between types L and R.
7585 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007586 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7587 return;
7588
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007589 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7590 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7591 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7592 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007593 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7594 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007595 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7596 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007597 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007598 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007599 }
7600 }
7601 }
7602
7603 // C++ [over.built]p20:
7604 //
7605 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7606 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7607 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7608 //
7609 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
7610 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7611 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7612 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7613
7614 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7615 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7616 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7617 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7618 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7619 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7620 continue;
7621
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007622 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007623 }
7624
7625 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7626 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7627 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7628 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7629 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7630 continue;
7631
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007632 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007633 }
7634 }
7635 }
7636
7637 // C++ [over.built]p19:
7638 //
7639 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7640 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7641 // of the form
7642 //
7643 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7644 //
7645 // C++ [over.built]p21:
7646 //
7647 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7648 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7649 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7650 //
7651 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7652 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7653 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7654 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7655 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7656
7657 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7658 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7659 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7660 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7661 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7662 if (isEqualOp)
7663 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007664 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7665 continue;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007666
7667 // non-volatile version
7668 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7669 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7670 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7671 };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007672 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007673 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7674
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007675 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7676 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7677 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007678 // volatile version
7679 ParamTypes[0] =
7680 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007681 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007682 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7683 }
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007684
7685 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7686 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7687 // restrict version
7688 ParamTypes[0]
7689 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007690 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007691 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7692
7693 if (NeedVolatile) {
7694 // volatile restrict version
7695 ParamTypes[0]
7696 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7697 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7698 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7699 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007700 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007701 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7702 }
7703 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007704 }
7705
7706 if (isEqualOp) {
7707 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7708 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7709 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7710 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7711 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7712 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7713 continue;
7714
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007715 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7716 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7717 *Ptr,
7718 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007719
7720 // non-volatile version
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007721 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007722 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7723
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007724 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7725 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7726 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007727 // volatile version
7728 ParamTypes[0] =
7729 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007730 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7731 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007732 }
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007733
7734 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7735 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7736 // restrict version
7737 ParamTypes[0]
7738 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007739 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7740 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007741
7742 if (NeedVolatile) {
7743 // volatile restrict version
7744 ParamTypes[0]
7745 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7746 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7747 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7748 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007749 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7750 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor5bee2582012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007751 }
7752 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007753 }
7754 }
7755 }
7756
7757 // C++ [over.built]p18:
7758 //
7759 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7760 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7761 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7762 // the form
7763 //
7764 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
7765 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7766 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7767 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7768 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7769 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007770 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7771 return;
7772
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007773 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7774 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7775 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7776 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007777 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007778
7779 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7780 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007781 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007782 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007783 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7784
7785 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7786 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7787 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007788 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007789 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007790 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007791 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7792 }
7793 }
7794 }
7795
7796 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7797 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7798 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7799 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7800 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7801 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7802 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7803 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7804 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7805 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7806 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7807 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7808 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007809 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007810 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7811
7812 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7813 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7814 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7815 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007816 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007817 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7818 }
7819 }
7820 }
7821 }
7822
7823 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7824 //
7825 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7826 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7827 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7828 //
7829 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7830 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7831 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7832 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7833 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7834 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7835 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007836 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7837 return;
7838
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007839 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7840 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7841 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7842 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007843 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007844
7845 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7846 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007847 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007848 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007849 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7850 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007851 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007852 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7853 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007854 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007855 }
7856 }
7857 }
7858 }
7859
7860 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7861 //
7862 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7863 //
7864 // bool operator!(bool);
7865 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7866 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7867 void addExclaimOverload() {
7868 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007869 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007870 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7871 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7872 }
7873 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7874 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007875 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007876 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7877 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7878 }
7879
7880 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7881 //
7882 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7883 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7884 //
7885 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7886 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7887 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7888 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7889 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7890 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7891 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7892 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7893 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7894 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7895 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7896 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007897 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7898 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007899
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007900 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7901
7902 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007903 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007904 }
7905
7906 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7907 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7908 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7909 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7910 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7911 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007912 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7913 continue;
7914
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007915 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7916
7917 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007918 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007919 }
7920 }
7921
7922 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7923 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7924 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7925 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7926 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7927 //
7928 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7929 //
7930 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7931 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7932 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7933 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7934 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7935 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7936 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7937 QualType C1;
7938 QualifierCollector Q1;
7939 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7940 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7941 continue;
7942 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7943 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7944 // volatile/restrict type.
7945 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7946 continue;
7947 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7948 continue;
7949 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7950 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7951 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7952 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7953 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7954 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7955 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7956 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7957 break;
7958 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7959 // build CV12 T&
7960 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7961 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7962 T.isVolatileQualified())
7963 continue;
7964 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7965 T.isRestrictQualified())
7966 continue;
7967 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7968 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007969 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007970 }
7971 }
7972 }
7973
7974 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7975 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7976 // therefore added as binary.
7977 //
7978 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7979 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7980 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7981 //
7982 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7983 //
7984 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7985 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7986 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7987
7988 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7989 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7990 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7991 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7992 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7993 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7994 continue;
7995
7996 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007997 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007998 }
7999
8000 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8001 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
8002 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
8003 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
8004 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
8005 continue;
8006
8007 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008008 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008009 }
8010
Richard Smith2bf7fdb2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00008011 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008012 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8013 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
8014 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
8015 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
8016 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
8017 continue;
8018
8019 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
8020 continue;
8021
8022 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008023 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008024 }
8025 }
8026 }
8027 }
8028};
8029
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008030} // end anonymous namespace
8031
8032/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
8033/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
8034/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
8035/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
8036/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
Robert Wilhelm16e94b92013-08-09 18:02:13 +00008037void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
8038 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8039 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8040 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008041 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
8042 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008043 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
8044 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00008045 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
8046 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008047 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00008048 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008049
8050 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
8051 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008052 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008053 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00008054 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
8055 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
8056 OpLoc,
8057 true,
8058 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
8059 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
8060 Op == OO_PipePipe),
8061 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008062 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
8063 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
8064 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
8065 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
8066 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00008067 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008068
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008069 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
8070 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor877d4eb2011-10-10 14:05:31 +00008071 //
8072 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
8073 // 'bool' overloads.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008074 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
Douglas Gregor877d4eb2011-10-10 14:05:31 +00008075 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008076 return;
8077
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008078 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008079 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008080 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00008081 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008082 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
8083
8084 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008085 switch (Op) {
8086 case OO_None:
8087 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008088 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008089
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008090 case OO_New:
8091 case OO_Delete:
8092 case OO_Array_New:
8093 case OO_Array_Delete:
8094 case OO_Call:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008095 llvm_unreachable(
8096 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008097
8098 case OO_Comma:
8099 case OO_Arrow:
8100 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8101 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
8102 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008103 break;
8104
8105 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008106 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008107 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00008108 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008109
8110 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008111 if (Args.size() == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008112 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00008113 } else {
8114 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
8115 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8116 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008117 break;
8118
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008119 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008120 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008121 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
8122 else
8123 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8124 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008125
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008126 case OO_Slash:
8127 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00008128 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008129
8130 case OO_PlusPlus:
8131 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008132 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8133 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008134 break;
8135
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00008136 case OO_EqualEqual:
8137 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008138 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00008139 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00008140
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008141 case OO_Less:
8142 case OO_Greater:
8143 case OO_LessEqual:
8144 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00008145 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00008146 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
8147 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008148
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008149 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008150 case OO_Caret:
8151 case OO_Pipe:
8152 case OO_LessLess:
8153 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008154 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008155 break;
8156
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008157 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +00008158 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00008159 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8160 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
8161 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
8162 break;
8163
8164 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8165 break;
8166
8167 case OO_Tilde:
8168 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
8169 break;
8170
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008171 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008172 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00008173 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008174
8175 case OO_PlusEqual:
8176 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008177 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008178 // Fall through.
8179
8180 case OO_StarEqual:
8181 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008182 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008183 break;
8184
8185 case OO_PercentEqual:
8186 case OO_LessLessEqual:
8187 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
8188 case OO_AmpEqual:
8189 case OO_CaretEqual:
8190 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008191 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008192 break;
8193
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008194 case OO_Exclaim:
8195 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008196 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00008197
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008198 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008199 case OO_PipePipe:
8200 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008201 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008202
8203 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008204 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008205 break;
8206
8207 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008208 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008209 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00008210
8211 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00008212 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00008213 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8214 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008215 }
8216}
8217
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008218/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
8219/// to the set of overloading candidates.
8220///
8221/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
8222/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
8223/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
8224/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008225void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008226Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00008227 SourceLocation Loc,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008228 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00008229 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008230 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithb6626742012-10-18 17:56:02 +00008231 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00008232 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008233
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00008234 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
8235 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
8236 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
8237 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
8238 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
8239 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
8240
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008241 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +00008242 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008243
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00008244 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00008245 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
8246 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
8247 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00008248 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00008249 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00008250 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00008251 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00008252 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00008253
8254 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
8255 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00008256 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008257 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008258 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008259 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008260 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008261
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008262 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
8263 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008264 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008265 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008266 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008267 Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00008268 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008269}
8270
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008271/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
8272/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008273bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008274isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00008275 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
8276 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008277 SourceLocation Loc,
8278 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008279 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
8280 // functions.
8281 if (!Cand2.Viable)
8282 return Cand1.Viable;
8283 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
8284 return false;
8285
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008286 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
8287 //
8288 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
8289 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
8290 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
8291 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
8292 unsigned StartArg = 0;
8293 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
8294 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008295
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008296 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008297 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
8298 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008299 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008300 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
8301 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008302 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008303 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008304 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8305 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008306 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
8307 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8308 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
8309 HasBetterConversion = true;
8310 break;
8311
8312 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8313 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
8314 return false;
8315
8316 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8317 // Do nothing.
8318 break;
8319 }
8320 }
8321
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008322 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008323 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008324 if (HasBetterConversion)
8325 return true;
8326
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008327 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
8328 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
8329 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
8330 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
8331 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
8332 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008333 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008334 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008335 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00008336 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
8337 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
8338 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
8339 // pointer or block.
Richard Smithec2748a2014-05-17 04:36:39 +00008340 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
8341 compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
8342 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
8343 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
8344 Cand1.FinalConversion,
8345 Cand2.FinalConversion);
Richard Smith6fdeaab2014-05-17 01:58:45 +00008346
Richard Smithec2748a2014-05-17 04:36:39 +00008347 if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
8348 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Richard Smith6fdeaab2014-05-17 01:58:45 +00008349
8350 // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions
8351 // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per
8352 // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3.
8353 }
8354
8355 // -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
8356 // specialization, or, if not that,
8357 bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function &&
8358 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
8359 bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function &&
8360 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
8361 if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization)
8362 return Cand2IsSpecialization;
8363
8364 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
8365 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
8366 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
8367 // if not that,
8368 if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) {
8369 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
8370 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
8371 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
8372 Loc,
8373 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
8374 : TPOC_Call,
8375 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments,
8376 Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments))
8377 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008378 }
8379
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008380 // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution.
8381 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
8382 (Cand1.Function->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>() ||
8383 Cand2.Function->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>())) {
8384 // FIXME: The next several lines are just
8385 // specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> but going in declaration order,
8386 // instead of reverse order which is how they're stored in the AST.
8387 AttrVec Cand1Attrs;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008388 if (Cand1.Function->hasAttrs()) {
8389 Cand1Attrs = Cand1.Function->getAttrs();
Richard Smith9516eee2014-05-17 02:21:47 +00008390 Cand1Attrs.erase(std::remove_if(Cand1Attrs.begin(), Cand1Attrs.end(),
8391 IsNotEnableIfAttr),
8392 Cand1Attrs.end());
8393 std::reverse(Cand1Attrs.begin(), Cand1Attrs.end());
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008394 }
8395
8396 AttrVec Cand2Attrs;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008397 if (Cand2.Function->hasAttrs()) {
8398 Cand2Attrs = Cand2.Function->getAttrs();
Richard Smith9516eee2014-05-17 02:21:47 +00008399 Cand2Attrs.erase(std::remove_if(Cand2Attrs.begin(), Cand2Attrs.end(),
8400 IsNotEnableIfAttr),
8401 Cand2Attrs.end());
8402 std::reverse(Cand2Attrs.begin(), Cand2Attrs.end());
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008403 }
Richard Smith9516eee2014-05-17 02:21:47 +00008404
8405 // Candidate 1 is better if it has strictly more attributes and
8406 // the common sequence is identical.
8407 if (Cand1Attrs.size() <= Cand2Attrs.size())
8408 return false;
8409
8410 auto Cand1I = Cand1Attrs.begin();
8411 for (auto &Cand2A : Cand2Attrs) {
8412 auto &Cand1A = *Cand1I++;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008413 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID;
Richard Smith9516eee2014-05-17 02:21:47 +00008414 cast<EnableIfAttr>(Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID,
8415 S.getASTContext(), true);
8416 cast<EnableIfAttr>(Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID,
8417 S.getASTContext(), true);
Nick Lewyckyd950ae72014-01-21 01:30:30 +00008418 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID)
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008419 return false;
8420 }
Richard Smith9516eee2014-05-17 02:21:47 +00008421
8422 return true;
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00008423 }
8424
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008425 return false;
8426}
8427
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008428/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008429/// within an overload candidate set.
8430///
James Dennettffad8b72012-06-22 08:10:18 +00008431/// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008432/// which overload resolution occurs.
8433///
James Dennettffad8b72012-06-22 08:10:18 +00008434/// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
8435/// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008436///
8437/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008438OverloadingResult
8439OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00008440 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008441 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008442 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008443 Best = end();
8444 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
8445 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008446 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008447 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008448 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008449 }
8450
8451 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008452 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008453 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
8454
8455 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
8456 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008457 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008458 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008459 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008460 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008461 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008462 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008463 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008464 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008465 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008466
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008467 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008468 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008469 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
8470 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008471 return OR_Deleted;
8472
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008473 return OR_Success;
8474}
8475
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008476namespace {
8477
8478enum OverloadCandidateKind {
8479 oc_function,
8480 oc_method,
8481 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008482 oc_function_template,
8483 oc_method_template,
8484 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008485 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
8486 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008487 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008488 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008489 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008490 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008491};
8492
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008493OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
8494 FunctionDecl *Fn,
8495 std::string &Description) {
8496 bool isTemplate = false;
8497
8498 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
8499 isTemplate = true;
8500 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8501 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
8502 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008503
8504 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008505 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008506 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008507
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008508 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
8509 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
8510
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008511 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
8512 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
8513
8514 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
8515 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
8516
8517 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
8518 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
8519 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008520 }
8521
8522 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8523 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
8524 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008525 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008526 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008527
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008528 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
8529 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
8530
Douglas Gregor12695102012-02-10 08:36:38 +00008531 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
8532 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
8533
8534 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
8535 return oc_method;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008536 }
8537
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008538 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008539}
8540
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008541void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *Fn) {
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008542 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
8543 if (!Ctor) return;
8544
8545 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
8546 if (!Ctor) return;
8547
8548 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
8549}
8550
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008551} // end anonymous namespace
8552
8553// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008554void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008555 std::string FnDesc;
8556 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008557 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8558 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
8559 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
8560 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008561 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008562}
8563
Nick Lewyckyed4265c2013-09-22 10:06:01 +00008564// Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008565// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008566void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008567 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8568
8569 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
8570 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
8571
8572 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8573 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8574 I != IEnd; ++I) {
8575 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
8576 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008577 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008578 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
8579 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008580 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008581 }
8582 }
8583}
8584
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008585/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
8586/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
8587/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008588void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
8589 Sema &S,
8590 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
8591 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
8592 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
8593 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
Matt Beaumont-Gay641bd892012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008594 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
8595 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
8596 // refactoring here.
8597 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
8598 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8599 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8600 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8601 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8602 break;
8603 ++CandsShown;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008604 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008605 }
Matt Beaumont-Gay641bd892012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008606 if (I != E)
8607 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008608}
8609
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008610namespace {
8611
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008612void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
8613 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8614 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008615 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8616 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8617
8618 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8619 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
8620 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008621 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008622 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008623 if (I == 0)
8624 isObjectArgument = true;
8625 else
8626 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008627 }
8628
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008629 std::string FnDesc;
8630 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8631
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008632 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8633 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8634 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008635
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008636 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008637 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008638 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8639 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8640 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00008641 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008642
8643 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8644 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8645 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8646 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008647 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008648 return;
8649 }
8650
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008651 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8652 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008653 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8654 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8655 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8656 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8657 else {
8658 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8659 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8660 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8661 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8662 }
8663
8664 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8665 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008666 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8667 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8668
8669 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8670 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8671 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8672 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8673 << FromTy
8674 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8675 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008676 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008677 return;
8678 }
8679
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008680 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscff00d92011-06-24 00:08:59 +00008681 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008682 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8683 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8684 << FromTy
8685 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8686 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8687 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8688 return;
8689 }
8690
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00008691 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8692 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8693 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8694 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8695 << FromTy
8696 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8697 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8698 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8699 return;
8700 }
8701
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008702 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8703 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8704
8705 if (isObjectArgument) {
8706 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8707 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8708 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8709 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8710 } else {
8711 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8712 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8713 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8714 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8715 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008716 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008717 return;
8718 }
8719
Sebastian Redla72462c2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00008720 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8721 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8722 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8723 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8724 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8725 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8726 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8727 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8728 return;
8729 }
8730
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008731 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8732 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8733 // the failure.
8734 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8735 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8736 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8737 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8738 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8739 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8740 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8741 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008742 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008743 return;
8744 }
8745
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008746 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008747 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008748 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8749 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8750 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8751 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8752 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8753 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008754 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008755 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008756 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008757 }
8758 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8759 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8760 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8761 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8762 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8763 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8764 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8765 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8766 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008767 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8768 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain9ea8f7e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008769 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8770 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8771 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8772 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8773 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8774 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8775 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8776 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain9ea8f7e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008777 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8778 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8779 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8780 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8781 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8782 return;
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008783 }
Kaelyn Uhrain9ea8f7e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008784 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008785
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008786 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008787 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008788 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008789 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8790 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008791 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008792 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008793 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008794 return;
8795 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008796
Fariborz Jahaniana644f9c2011-07-20 17:14:09 +00008797 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
8798 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
8799 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8800 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8801 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8802 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
8803 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8804 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8805 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8806 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8807 return;
8808 }
8809 }
8810
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008811 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
8812 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
8813 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008814 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008815 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
8816 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
8817
8818 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer490afa62012-01-14 21:05:10 +00008819 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
8820 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008821 FDiag << *HI;
8822 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8823
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008824 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008825}
8826
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008827/// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload
8828/// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch()
8829/// over a candidate in any candidate set.
8830bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8831 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008832 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008833 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008834
Douglas Gregor1d33f8d2011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008835 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008836 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the
Douglas Gregor1d33f8d2011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008837 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8838 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8839 // Just don't report anything.
8840 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8841 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008842 return true;
8843
8844 if (NumArgs < MinParams) {
8845 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8846 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8847 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
8848 } else {
8849 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8850 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8851 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
8852 }
8853
8854 return false;
8855}
8856
8857/// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set.
8858void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, Decl *D, unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8859 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
8860 "The templated declaration should at least be a function"
8861 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many"
8862 " or too few arguments");
8863
8864 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
8865
8866 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8867 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8868 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregor1d33f8d2011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008869
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008870 // at least / at most / exactly
8871 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8872 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008873 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() ||
8874 FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008875 mode = 0; // "at least"
8876 else
8877 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8878 modeCount = MinParams;
8879 } else {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008880 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008881 mode = 1; // "at most"
8882 else
8883 mode = 2; // "exactly"
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008884 modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams();
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008885 }
8886
8887 std::string Description;
8888 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8889
Richard Smith10ff50d2012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008890 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
8891 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00008892 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr)
8893 << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
Richard Smith10ff50d2012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008894 else
8895 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00008896 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr)
8897 << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008898 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008899}
8900
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008901/// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate.
8902void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8903 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8904 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs))
8905 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs);
8906}
Larisse Voufo47c08452013-07-19 22:53:23 +00008907
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008908TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) {
8909 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))
8910 return FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
8911 else if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Templated))
8912 return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate();
8913
8914 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration"
8915 " for bad deduction diagnosis");
8916}
8917
8918/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8919void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, Decl *Templated,
8920 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure,
8921 unsigned NumArgs) {
8922 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008923 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8924 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8925 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8926 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008927 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008928 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8929 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8930
8931 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008932 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008933 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8934 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8935 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8936 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008937 return;
8938 }
8939
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008940 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8941 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8942 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8943
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008944 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008945
8946 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8947 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008948 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008949 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008950 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008951 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8952
8953 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8954 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8955 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8956 // done on dependent types).
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008957 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008958
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008959 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8960 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
8961 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008962 return;
8963 }
8964
8965 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008966 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008967 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008968 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008969 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008970 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008971 which = 1;
8972 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008973 which = 2;
8974 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008975
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008976 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8977 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
8978 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8979 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
8980 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008981 return;
8982 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008983
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008984 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008985 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008986 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008987 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008988 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008989 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008990 else {
8991 int index = 0;
8992 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8993 index = TTP->getIndex();
8994 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8995 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8996 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8997 else
8998 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008999 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00009000 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009001 << (index + 1);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00009002 }
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009003 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00009004 return;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009005
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00009006 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
9007 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009008 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Templated, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00009009 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00009010
9011 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009012 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9013 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
9014 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00009015 return;
9016
9017 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009018 // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009019 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009020 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009021 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009022 TemplateArgString = " ";
9023 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009024 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009025 }
9026
Richard Smith6f8d2c62012-05-09 05:17:00 +00009027 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009028 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
Richard Smith6f8d2c62012-05-09 05:17:00 +00009029 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
9030 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
9031 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
9032 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
9033 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
9034 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
9035 return;
9036 }
9037
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009038 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
9039 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
9040 // formatted message in another diagnostic.
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009041 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009042 SourceRange R;
Richard Smith6f8d2c62012-05-09 05:17:00 +00009043 if (PDiag) {
Richard Smith9ca64612012-05-07 09:03:25 +00009044 SFINAEArgString = ": ";
9045 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
9046 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
9047 }
9048
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009049 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9050 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
9051 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
9052 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00009053 return;
9054 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009055
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +00009056 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: {
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009057 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(DeductionFailure.getExpr());
9058 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +00009059 diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution)
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009060 << R.Expression->getName();
Richard Smith8c6eeb92013-01-31 04:03:12 +00009061 return;
9062 }
9063
Richard Trieue3732352013-04-08 21:11:40 +00009064 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00009065 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009066 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
9067 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Richard Trieue3732352013-04-08 21:11:40 +00009068 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
9069 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
9070 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
9071 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
9072 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
9073 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
9074 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
9075 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
9076 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
9077 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since:
9078 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
9079 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
9080 // name for types, not decls.
9081 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009082 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Richard Trieue3732352013-04-08 21:11:40 +00009083 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
9084 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
9085 return;
9086 }
9087 }
9088 }
Faisal Vali2b391ab2013-09-26 19:54:12 +00009089 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda
9090 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative
9091 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to
9092 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters.
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009093 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9094 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
9095 << FirstTA << SecondTA;
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00009096 return;
Richard Trieue3732352013-04-08 21:11:40 +00009097 }
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00009098 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
9099 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00009100 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009101 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
9102 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00009103 return;
9104 }
9105}
9106
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009107/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls.
9108void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned NumArgs) {
9109 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result;
9110 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) {
9111 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs))
9112 return;
9113 }
9114 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->Function, // pattern
9115 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs);
9116}
9117
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009118/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
9119void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9120 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9121 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
9122
9123 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
9124 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
9125
9126 std::string FnDesc;
9127 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
9128
9129 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
9130 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
9131}
9132
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00009133void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9134 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
9135 EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data);
9136
9137 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
9138 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr)
9139 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
9140}
9141
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00009142/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
9143/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
9144///
9145/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
9146/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
9147/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
9148/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
9149/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
9150/// overload.
9151///
9152/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
9153/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
9154/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009155void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009156 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00009157 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
9158
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009159 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00009160 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
9161 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009162 std::string FnDesc;
9163 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00009164
9165 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
Richard Smith6f1e2c62012-04-02 20:59:25 +00009166 << FnKind << FnDesc
9167 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00009168 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009169 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009170 }
9171
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009172 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
9173 if (Cand->Viable) {
9174 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
9175 return;
9176 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009177
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00009178 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
9179 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
9180 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
9181 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009182
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00009183 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009184 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00009185
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009186 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
9187 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00009188 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00009189 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009190
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00009191 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
9192 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009193 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00009194 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
9195 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009196
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00009197 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
9198 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
9199 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
9200 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00009201 }
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009202
9203 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
9204 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +00009205
9206 case ovl_fail_enable_if:
9207 return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00009208 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009209}
9210
9211void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9212 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
9213 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
9214 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
9215 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
9216 bool isLValueReference = false;
9217 bool isRValueReference = false;
9218 bool isPointer = false;
9219 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
9220 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
9221 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
9222 isLValueReference = true;
9223 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
9224 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
9225 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
9226 isRValueReference = true;
9227 }
9228 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9229 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9230 isPointer = true;
9231 }
9232 // Desugar down to a function type.
9233 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
9234 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
9235 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
9236 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
9237 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
9238
9239 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
9240 << FnType;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00009241 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009242}
9243
9244void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
David Blaikie1d202a62012-10-08 01:11:04 +00009245 StringRef Opc,
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009246 SourceLocation OpLoc,
9247 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009248 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009249 std::string TypeStr("operator");
9250 TypeStr += Opc;
9251 TypeStr += "(";
9252 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009253 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009254 TypeStr += ")";
9255 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
9256 } else {
9257 TypeStr += ", ";
9258 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
9259 TypeStr += ")";
9260 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
9261 }
9262}
9263
9264void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9265 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009266 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009267 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
9268 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009269 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
9270 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
9271
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009272 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00009273 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009274 }
9275}
9276
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009277static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009278 if (Cand->Function)
9279 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00009280 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009281 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
9282 return SourceLocation();
9283}
9284
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009285static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth73fddfe2011-09-10 00:51:24 +00009286 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009287 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009288 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00009289
Douglas Gregorc5c01a62012-09-13 21:01:57 +00009290 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009291 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
9292 return 1;
9293
9294 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
9295 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
9296 return 2;
9297
9298 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
9299 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Richard Smith44ecdbd2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00009300 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009301 return 3;
9302
9303 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
9304 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
9305 return 4;
9306
9307 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
9308 return 5;
9309
9310 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
9311 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
9312 return 6;
9313 }
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00009314 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009315}
9316
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00009317struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
9318 Sema &S;
Kaelyn Takatab96b3be2014-05-01 21:15:24 +00009319 size_t NumArgs;
9320
9321 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S, size_t nArgs)
9322 : S(S), NumArgs(nArgs) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009323
9324 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
9325 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00009326 // Fast-path this check.
9327 if (L == R) return false;
9328
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009329 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00009330 if (L->Viable) {
9331 if (!R->Viable) return true;
9332
9333 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
9334 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
9335 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009336 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
9337 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00009338 } else if (R->Viable)
9339 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009340
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009341 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009342
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009343 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
9344 if (!L->Viable) {
9345 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
9346 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
Kaelyn Takatab96b3be2014-05-01 21:15:24 +00009347 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
9348 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9349 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
Kaelyn Takata50c4ffc2014-05-07 00:43:38 +00009350 int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
9351 int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
9352 if (LDist == RDist) {
9353 if (L->FailureKind == R->FailureKind)
9354 // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates.
9355 return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate;
9356 // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were
9357 // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters
9358 // than there were arguments given.
9359 return L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
9360 }
Kaelyn Takatab96b3be2014-05-01 21:15:24 +00009361 return LDist < RDist;
9362 }
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009363 return false;
Kaelyn Takatab96b3be2014-05-01 21:15:24 +00009364 }
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009365 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9366 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
9367 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009368
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009369 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
9370 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
9371 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
9372 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
9373 return true;
9374
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009375 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
9376 // comes first.
9377 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
9378 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
9379 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
9380 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00009381 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009382 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
9383 return true;
9384 else
9385 return false;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00009386 }
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009387
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009388 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
9389 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009390 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009391
9392 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00009393 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009394 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009395 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
9396 L->Conversions[I],
9397 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009398 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
9399 leftBetter++;
9400 break;
9401
9402 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
9403 leftBetter--;
9404 break;
9405
9406 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
9407 break;
9408 }
9409 }
9410 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
9411 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
9412
9413 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
9414 return false;
9415
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009416 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
9417 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
9418 return true;
9419
9420 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
9421 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedman1e7a0c62011-10-14 23:10:30 +00009422 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedmane2c600c2011-10-14 21:52:24 +00009423 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
9424 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009425
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009426 // TODO: others?
9427 }
9428
9429 // Sort everything else by location.
9430 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
9431 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
9432
9433 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
9434 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
9435 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
9436
9437 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009438 }
9439};
9440
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009441/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009442/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009443void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009444 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009445 assert(!Cand->Viable);
9446
9447 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
9448 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
9449
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009450 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
9451 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00009452 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
9453 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009454
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009455 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00009456 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009457 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009458 while (true) {
9459 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
9460 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009461 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00009462 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009463 break;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009464 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009465 }
9466
9467 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
9468 return;
9469
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00009470 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
9471 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
9472
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00009473 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009474 // operation somehow.
9475 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009476
9477 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
9478 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
9479
9480 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
9481 QualType ConvType
9482 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
9483 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
9484 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
9485 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9486 ArgIdx--;
9487 } else if (Cand->Function) {
9488 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9489 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
9490 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
9491 ArgIdx--;
9492 } else {
9493 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
9494 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
9495 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
9496 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00009497 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
9498 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009499 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009500 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
9501 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009502 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009503 return;
9504 }
9505
9506 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00009507 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009508 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00009509 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00009510 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization(
9511 S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx), SuppressUserConversions,
9512 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
9513 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
9514 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009515 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
9516 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00009517 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009518 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009519 else
9520 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
9521 }
9522}
9523
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009524} // end anonymous namespace
9525
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009526/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
9527/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009528/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009529void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
9530 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009531 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
David Blaikie1d202a62012-10-08 01:11:04 +00009532 StringRef Opc,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009533 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009534 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
9535 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009536 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009537 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
9538 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009539 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009540 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009541 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009542 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009543 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
9544 Cands.push_back(Cand);
9545 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
9546 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009547 }
9548 }
9549
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00009550 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
Kaelyn Takatab96b3be2014-05-01 21:15:24 +00009551 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, Args.size()));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009552
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009553 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009554
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009555 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
Douglas Gregor79591782012-10-23 23:11:23 +00009556 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009557 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009558 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9559 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00009560
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009561 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
9562 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9563 // candidate list.
Douglas Gregor79591782012-10-23 23:11:23 +00009564 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009565 break;
9566 }
9567 ++CandsShown;
9568
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009569 if (Cand->Function)
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009570 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009571 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009572 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009573 else {
9574 assert(Cand->Viable &&
9575 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009576 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
9577 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
9578 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
9579 //
9580 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
9581 // different ambiguities, though.
9582 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009583 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009584 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
9585 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009586
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009587 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009588 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00009589 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009590 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009591
9592 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009593 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009594}
9595
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009596static SourceLocation
9597GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) {
9598 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation()
9599 : SourceLocation();
9600}
9601
9602struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay {
9603 Sema &S;
9604 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
9605
9606 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L,
9607 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) {
9608 // Fast-path this check.
9609 if (L == R)
9610 return false;
9611
9612 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches...
9613
9614 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures.
9615 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
9616 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) <
9617 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
9618
9619 // Sort everything else by location.
9620 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
9621 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
9622
9623 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
9624 if (LLoc.isInvalid())
9625 return false;
9626 if (RLoc.isInvalid())
9627 return true;
9628
9629 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
9630 }
9631};
9632
9633/// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure.
9634/// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad
9635/// deductions.
9636void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S) {
9637 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Specialization, // pattern
9638 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0);
9639}
9640
9641void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
9642 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
9643 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
9644 }
9645}
9646
9647void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() {
9648 destroyCandidates();
9649 Candidates.clear();
9650}
9651
9652/// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints
9653/// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form
9654/// the candidate set.
9655/// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with
9656/// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false.
9657void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
9658 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match).
9659 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers
9660 // and sort those.
9661 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands;
9662 Cands.reserve(size());
9663 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
9664 if (Cand->Specialization)
9665 Cands.push_back(Cand);
Alp Tokerd4733632013-12-05 04:47:09 +00009666 // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate. We do not,
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009667 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate.
9668 }
9669
9670 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
9671 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S));
9672
9673 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads()
9674 // for generalization purposes (?).
9675 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
9676
9677 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E;
9678 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
9679 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9680 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I;
9681
9682 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam
9683 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9684 // candidate list.
9685 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
9686 break;
9687 ++CandsShown;
9688
9689 assert(Cand->Specialization &&
9690 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
9691 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S);
9692 }
9693
9694 if (I != E)
9695 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
9696}
9697
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009698// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
9699// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
9700// R (A) --> R(A)
9701// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
9702// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
9703// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
9704QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
9705 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
9706 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
9707 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
9708 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9709 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
9710 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9711 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009712 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009713 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
9714 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9715 Ret =
9716 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
9717 return Ret;
9718}
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009719
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009720// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
9721// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
9722class AddressOfFunctionResolver
9723{
9724 Sema& S;
9725 Expr* SourceExpr;
9726 const QualType& TargetType;
9727 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
9728
9729 bool Complain;
9730 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
9731 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009732
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009733 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
9734 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009735 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009736
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009737 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
9738 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
9739 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009740 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009741 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009742
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009743public:
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009744 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr,
9745 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain)
9746 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
9747 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
9748 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
9749 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
9750 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009751 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false),
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009752 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
9753 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression),
9754 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc()) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009755 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009756
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009757 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
9758 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr))
9759 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() &&
9760 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME))
9761 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true;
9762 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9763 DeclAccessPair dap;
9764 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9765 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) {
9766 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn))
9767 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9768 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found
9769 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the
9770 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
9771 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009772
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009773 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
9774 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
9775 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
9776 return;
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009777 }
9778
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009779 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn));
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009780 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009781 return;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009782 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009783
9784 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
9785 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009786
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009787 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
9788 // C++ [over.over]p4:
9789 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
9790 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
9791 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
9792 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
9793 else
9794 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
9795 }
9796 }
9797 }
9798
9799private:
9800 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
9801 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
9802 }
9803
9804 // [ToType] [Return]
9805
9806 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9807 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9808 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
9809 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
9810 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
9811 }
9812
9813 // return true if any matching specializations were found
9814 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
9815 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
9816 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
9817 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9818 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
9819 // static when converting to member pointer.
9820 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9821 return false;
9822 }
9823 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9824 return false;
9825
9826 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9827 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9828 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9829 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9830 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9831 // overloaded functions considered.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00009832 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009833 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009834 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
9835 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
9836 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
9837 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
Douglas Gregor19a41f12013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009838 Info, /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009839 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9840 FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
9841 .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
9842 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009843 return false;
9844 }
9845
Douglas Gregor19a41f12013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009846 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
9847 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009848 // This function template specicalization works.
9849 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor19a41f12013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009850 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
9851 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
9852 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009853 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
9854 return true;
9855 }
9856
9857 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
9858 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009859 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009860 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
9861 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009862 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9863 return false;
9864 }
9865 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9866 return false;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009867
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009868 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009869 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009870 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
9871 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
9872 return false;
9873
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00009874 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
9875 // now.
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +00009876 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00009877 FunDecl->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00009878 S.DeduceReturnType(FunDecl, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), Complain))
9879 return false;
9880
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00009881 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009882 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
9883 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00009884 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
9885 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009886 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
9887 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009888 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009889 return true;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009890 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009891 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009892
9893 return false;
9894 }
9895
9896 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
9897 bool Ret = false;
9898
9899 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
9900 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
9901 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9902 return false;
9903
9904 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9905 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9906 I != E; ++I) {
9907 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
9908 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9909
9910 // C++ [over.over]p3:
9911 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
9912 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
9913 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
9914 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
9915 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
9916 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9917 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
9918 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
9919 Ret = true;
9920 }
9921 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
9922 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
9923 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
9924 Ret = true;
9925 }
9926 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
9927 return Ret;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009928 }
9929
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009930 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009931 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
9932 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
9933 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
9934 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
9935 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
9936
9937 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
9938 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
9939 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
9940 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009941
9942 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
9943 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
9944 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009945
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009946 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose
9947 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0.
9948 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized(
Richard Smith35e1da22013-09-10 22:59:25 +00009949 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates,
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009950 SourceExpr->getLocStart(), S.PDiag(),
9951 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) << Matches[0]
9952 .second->getDeclName(),
9953 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) << (unsigned)oc_function_template,
9954 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009955
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009956 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
9957 // Make it the first and only element
9958 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
9959 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
9960 Matches.resize(1);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009961 }
9962 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009963
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009964 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
9965 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
9966 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
9967 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +00009968 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr)
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009969 ++I;
9970 else {
9971 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
9972 Matches.set_size(N);
9973 }
9974 }
9975 }
9976
9977public:
9978 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
9979 assert(Matches.empty());
9980 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
9981 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
9982 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Smith0d905472013-08-14 00:00:44 +00009983 if (FailedCandidates.empty())
9984 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
9985 else {
9986 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose
9987 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates
9988 // normally.
9989 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9990 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9991 I != IEnd; ++I)
9992 if (FunctionDecl *Fun =
9993 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
9994 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, TargetFunctionType);
9995 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getLocStart());
9996 }
9997 }
9998
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009999 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
10000 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
10001 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
10002 }
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +000010003
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010004 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
10005 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
10006 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
10007 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
10008 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
10009 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
10010 }
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +000010011
10012 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
10013 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
10014 }
10015
10016 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
10017 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(),
10018 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
10019 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
10020 }
10021
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010022 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
10023 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
10024 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
10025 }
10026
10027 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
10028 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
10029 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
10030 << OvlExpr->getName()
10031 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +000010032 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010033 }
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +000010034
10035 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
10036
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010037 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
10038
10039 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010040 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010041 return Matches[0].second;
10042 }
10043
10044 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010045 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010046 return &Matches[0].first;
10047 }
10048};
10049
10050/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
10051/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
10052/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
10053/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
10054///
10055/// @code
10056/// int f(double);
10057/// int f(int);
10058///
10059/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
10060/// @endcode
10061///
10062/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
10063/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
10064/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
10065FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +000010066Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
10067 QualType TargetType,
10068 bool Complain,
10069 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
10070 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010071 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +000010072
10073 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
10074 Complain);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010075 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010076 FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +000010077 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010078 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
10079 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
10080 else
10081 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
10082 }
10083 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
10084 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
10085 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
10086 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
10087 assert(Fn);
10088 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
David Majnemera4f7c7a2013-08-01 06:13:59 +000010089 if (Complain) {
10090 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer())
10091 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer();
10092 else
10093 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
10094 }
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +000010095 }
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +000010096
10097 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
10098 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010099 return Fn;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010100}
10101
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010102/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010103/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
10104///
10105/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
10106/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010107/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010108/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
Alp Toker67b47ac2013-10-20 18:48:56 +000010109///
10110/// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
10111/// returned.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010112FunctionDecl *
10113Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
10114 bool Complain,
10115 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010116 // C++ [over.over]p1:
10117 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
10118 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010119 // C++ [over.over]p1:
10120 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
10121 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010122
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010123 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010124 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010125 return nullptr;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +000010126
10127 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010128 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +000010129 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010130
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010131 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
10132 // whose type matches exactly.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010133 FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010134 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
10135 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010136 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
10137 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010138 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
10139 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
10140 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010141 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +000010142 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
10143 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010144
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010145 // C++ [over.over]p2:
10146 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
10147 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
10148 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
10149 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
10150 // overloaded functions considered.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010151 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +000010152 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010153 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
10154 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor19a41f12013-04-17 08:45:07 +000010155 Specialization, Info,
10156 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
Larisse Voufo98b20f12013-07-19 23:00:19 +000010157 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
10158 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info?
10159 FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
10160 .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
10161 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010162 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010163 }
10164
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010165 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
10166
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010167 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010168 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010169 if (Complain) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010170 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
10171 << ovl->getName();
10172 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010173 }
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010174 return nullptr;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010175 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +000010176
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010177 Matched = Specialization;
10178 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010179 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010180
Aaron Ballmandd69ef32014-08-19 15:55:55 +000010181 if (Matched && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000010182 Matched->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +000010183 DeduceReturnType(Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010184 return nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +000010185
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +000010186 return Matched;
10187}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010188
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010189
10190
10191
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010192// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
10193// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
10194//
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010195// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010196//
10197// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
10198// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
10199// returns true if 'complain' is set.
10200bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
10201 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
10202 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010203 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010204 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010205 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010206
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010207 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010208
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010209 DeclAccessPair found;
10210 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
10211 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
10212 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010213 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010214 SrcExpr = ExprError();
10215 return true;
10216 }
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010217
10218 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
10219 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
10220 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
10221 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
10222 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
10223 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
10224 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010225 if (!complain) return false;
10226
10227 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
10228 diag::err_bound_member_function)
10229 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
10230
10231 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
10232 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
10233 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
10234 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
10235 // the static candidates were rejected.
10236 SrcExpr = ExprError();
10237 return true;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010238 }
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +000010239
Sylvestre Ledrua5202662012-07-31 06:56:50 +000010240 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010241 SingleFunctionExpression =
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010242 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn);
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010243
10244 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010245 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010246 SingleFunctionExpression =
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010247 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get());
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010248 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
10249 SrcExpr = ExprError();
10250 return true;
10251 }
10252 }
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010253 }
10254
10255 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
10256 if (complain) {
10257 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
10258 << ovl.Expression->getName()
10259 << DestTypeForComplaining
10260 << OpRangeForComplaining
10261 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010262 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
10263
10264 SrcExpr = ExprError();
10265 return true;
10266 }
10267
10268 return false;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010269 }
10270
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +000010271 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
10272 return true;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +000010273}
10274
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010275/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
10276static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010277 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +000010278 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +000010279 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010280 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010281 bool PartialOverloading,
10282 bool KnownValid) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010283 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010284 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
10285 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
10286
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010287 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010288 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
10289 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
10290 return;
10291 }
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010292 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
10293 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010294 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010295 }
10296
10297 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
10298 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010299 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010300 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010301 return;
10302 }
10303
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010304 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010305}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010306
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010307/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
10308/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010309void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +000010310 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010311 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10312 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010313
10314#ifndef NDEBUG
10315 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
10316 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010317 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010318 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
10319 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
10320 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
10321 //
10322 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
10323 //
10324 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010325 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010326 //
10327 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
10328 // template
10329 //
10330 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010331
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010332 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
10333 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
10334 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10335 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
10336 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
10337 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
10338 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010339 }
10340 }
10341#endif
10342
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010343 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
10344 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010345 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010346 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10347 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
10348 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
10349 }
10350
10351 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
10352 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010353 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
10354 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
10355 /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010356
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010357 if (ULE->requiresADL())
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010358 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010359 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Richard Smithb6626742012-10-18 17:56:02 +000010360 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010361}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010362
Richard Smith0603bbb2013-06-12 22:56:54 +000010363/// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
10364/// a different namespace.
10365static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
10366 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
10367 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
10368 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
10369 return false;
10370
10371 default:
10372 return true;
10373 }
10374}
10375
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010376/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
10377/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
10378/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
10379/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
10380///
10381/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
10382static bool
10383DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
10384 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010385 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010386 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +000010387 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010388 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
10389 return false;
10390
10391 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
Nick Lewyckyfcd5e7a2012-03-14 20:41:00 +000010392 if (DC->isTransparentContext())
10393 continue;
10394
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010395 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
10396
10397 if (!R.empty()) {
10398 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10399
10400 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
10401 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
10402 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
10403 R.clear();
10404 return false;
10405 }
10406
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010407 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010408 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
10409 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010410 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010411 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010412
10413 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010414 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010415 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
10416 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010417 R.clear();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010418 return false;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010419 }
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010420
10421 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
10422 // declaring the function there instead.
10423 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
10424 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
John McCall7d8b0412012-08-24 20:38:34 +000010425 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010426 AssociatedNamespaces,
10427 AssociatedClasses);
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010428 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Richard Smith0603bbb2013-06-12 22:56:54 +000010429 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
10430 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
10431 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
10432 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
10433 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
10434 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
10435 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
10436 continue;
Richard Smith21bae432012-12-22 02:46:14 +000010437
Richard Smith0603bbb2013-06-12 22:56:54 +000010438 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
10439 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
10440 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
10441 if (NS &&
10442 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
10443 continue;
10444
10445 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
10446 }
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010447 }
10448
10449 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10450 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010451 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010452 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10453 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10454 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010455 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010456 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10457 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010458 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010459 } else {
10460 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
10461 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
10462 // a localized representation of a list of items.
10463 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10464 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10465 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
10466 }
10467
10468 // Try to recover by calling this function.
10469 return true;
10470 }
10471
10472 R.clear();
10473 }
10474
10475 return false;
10476}
10477
10478/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
10479/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
10480/// was defined.
10481///
10482/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
10483static bool
10484DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
10485 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Dmitri Gribenkof8579502013-01-12 19:30:44 +000010486 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010487 DeclarationName OpName =
10488 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10489 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
10490 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010491 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010492 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010493}
10494
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +000010495namespace {
Richard Smith88d67f32012-09-25 04:46:05 +000010496class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
10497 Sema &SemaRef;
10498public:
10499 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
10500 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
10501 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
10502 }
10503
10504 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
10505 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
10506 }
10507};
10508
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +000010509}
10510
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010511/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
10512///
10513/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010514static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +000010515BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010516 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10517 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Craig Toppere3d2ecbe2014-06-28 23:22:33 +000010518 MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010519 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010520 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smith88d67f32012-09-25 04:46:05 +000010521 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
10522 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
10523 //
10524 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
10525 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
10526 //
10527 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
10528 return ExprError();
10529 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010530
10531 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010532 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010533 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010534
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010535 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010536 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010537 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10538 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
10539 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
10540 }
10541
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010542 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
10543 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Kaelyn Uhrain53e72192013-07-08 23:13:39 +000010544 FunctionCallFilterCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010545 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr,
Kaelyn Takatafb271f02014-04-04 22:16:30 +000010546 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn));
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010547 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
10548 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
10549 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
10550 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010551 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010552 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010553 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010554 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010555 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010556 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010557 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010558
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010559 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
10560
10561 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
10562 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010563 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010564 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010565 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
10566 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara65f7c3d2012-02-06 14:31:00 +000010567 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010568 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara65f7c3d2012-02-06 14:31:00 +000010569 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010570 else
10571 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
10572
10573 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010574 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010575
10576 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010577 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010578 // end up here.
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010579 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010580 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
10581 RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010582}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +000010583
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010584/// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
10585/// the given function.
10586/// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
10587bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10588 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010589 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010590 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10591 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10592 ExprResult *Result) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010593#ifndef NDEBUG
10594 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
10595 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
10596 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
10597
10598 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
10599 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
10600 FunctionDecl *F;
10601 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
10602 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
10603 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +000010604 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010605
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010606 // We don't perform ADL in C.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010607 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smithb6626742012-10-18 17:56:02 +000010608 }
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010609#endif
10610
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010611 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010612 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010613 *Result = ExprError();
10614 return true;
10615 }
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +000010616
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010617 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
10618 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010619 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010620
10621 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010622 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
10623 // out if it fails.
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010624 if (CandidateSet->empty()) {
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010625 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
10626 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +000010627 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010628 // classes.
Alp Tokerbfa39342014-01-14 12:51:41 +000010629 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetde232cb2011-11-25 01:10:54 +000010630 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010631 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args,
Benjamin Kramerc215e762012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010632 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10633 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010634 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010635 *Result = CE;
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010636 return true;
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010637 }
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010638 return false;
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +000010639 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010640
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010641 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010642 return false;
10643}
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010644
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010645/// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
10646/// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
10647/// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
10648static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10649 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10650 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010651 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010652 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10653 Expr *ExecConfig,
10654 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10655 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
10656 OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
10657 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10658 if (CandidateSet->empty())
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010659 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010660 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
10661 AllowTypoCorrection);
10662
10663 switch (OverloadResult) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010664 case OR_Success: {
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010665 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010666 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith22262ab2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000010667 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
10668 return ExprError();
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010669 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010670 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
10671 ExecConfig);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010672 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010673
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010674 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10675 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
10676 // have meant to call.
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010677 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010678 Args, RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010679 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
10680 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010681 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
10682 return Recovery;
10683
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010684 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010685 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010686 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010687 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010688 break;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010689 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010690
10691 case OR_Ambiguous:
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010692 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010693 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010694 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010695 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010696
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010697 case OR_Deleted: {
10698 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
10699 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
10700 << ULE->getName()
10701 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
10702 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010703 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3eaa22a2011-11-04 15:58:13 +000010704
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010705 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
10706 // the call in the AST.
10707 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
10708 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010709 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
10710 ExecConfig);
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010711 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010712 }
10713
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +000010714 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010715 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010716}
10717
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010718/// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
10719/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
10720/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
10721/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
10722/// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
10723/// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
10724ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10725 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10726 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010727 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010728 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10729 Expr *ExecConfig,
10730 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010731 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(),
10732 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010733 ExprResult result;
10734
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010735 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
10736 &result))
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010737 return result;
10738
10739 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10740 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
10741 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
10742
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010743 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010744 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
10745 &Best, OverloadResult,
10746 AllowTypoCorrection);
10747}
10748
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010749static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +000010750 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
10751 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
10752}
10753
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010754/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10755/// operator.
10756///
10757/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
10758///
10759/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10760/// operator.
10761///
James Dennett18348b62012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010762/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010763/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10764/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10765/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10766/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10767/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
10768///
James Dennett91738ff2012-06-22 10:32:46 +000010769/// \param Input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010770ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010771Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
10772 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010773 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010774 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010775
10776 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10777 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
10778 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010779 // TODO: provide better source location info.
10780 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010781
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010782 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
10783 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010784
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010785 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr };
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010786 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010787
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010788 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
10789 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
10790 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010791 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010792 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +000010793 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
10794 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010795 NumArgs = 2;
10796 }
10797
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010798 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
10799
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010800 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010801 if (Fns.empty())
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010802 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy,
10803 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010804
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010805 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010806 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010807 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010808 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010809 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
10810 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010811 return new (Context)
10812 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray, Context.DependentTy,
10813 VK_RValue, OpLoc, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010814 }
10815
10816 // Build an empty overload set.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010817 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010818
10819 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010820 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010821
10822 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010823 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010824
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010825 // Add candidates from ADL.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000010826 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010827 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr,
10828 CandidateSet);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010829
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010830 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010831 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010832
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010833 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10834
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010835 // Perform overload resolution.
10836 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010837 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010838 case OR_Success: {
10839 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10840 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010841
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010842 if (FnDecl) {
10843 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10844 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010845
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010846 // Convert the arguments.
10847 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010848 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010849
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010850 ExprResult InputRes =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010851 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010852 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10853 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010854 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010855 Input = InputRes.get();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010856 } else {
10857 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010858 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010859 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010860 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +000010861 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010862 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010863 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010864 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010865 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010866 Input = InputInit.get();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010867 }
10868
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010869 // Build the actual expression node.
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010870 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010871 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010872 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10873 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010874
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000010875 // Determine the result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000010876 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000010877 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10878 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10879
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +000010880 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010881 CallExpr *TheCall =
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010882 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray,
Lang Hames5de91cc2012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010883 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010884
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000010885 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +000010886 return ExprError();
10887
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010888 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010889 } else {
10890 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10891 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10892 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010893 ExprResult InputRes =
10894 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10895 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10896 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10897 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000010898 Input = InputRes.get();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010899 break;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010900 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010901 }
10902
10903 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010904 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10905 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10906 // defined too late to be candidates.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010907 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010908 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10909 return ExprError();
10910
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010911 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
10912 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
10913 break;
10914
10915 case OR_Ambiguous:
10916 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10917 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10918 << Input->getType()
10919 << Input->getSourceRange();
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010920 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, ArgsArray,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010921 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10922 return ExprError();
10923
10924 case OR_Deleted:
10925 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10926 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10927 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10928 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10929 << Input->getSourceRange();
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010930 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray,
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010931 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010932 return ExprError();
10933 }
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010934
10935 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
10936 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
10937 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010938 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010939}
10940
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010941/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10942/// operator.
10943///
10944/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10945///
10946/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10947/// operator.
10948///
James Dennett18348b62012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010949/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010950/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10951/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10952/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10953/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10954/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10955///
10956/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10957/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010958ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010959Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010960 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010961 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010962 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010963 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010964 LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010965
10966 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10967 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10968 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10969
10970 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10971 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010972 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010973 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010974 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010975 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010976 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010977 return new (Context) BinaryOperator(
10978 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
10979 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010980
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010981 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(
10982 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary,
10983 Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, OpLoc,
10984 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010985 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010986
10987 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000010988 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010989 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
10990 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010991 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010992 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10993 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10994 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010995 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000010996 return new (Context)
10997 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy,
10998 VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010999 }
11000
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011001 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
11002 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
11003 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011004
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +000011005 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
11006 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
11007 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011008 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
11009 return ExprError();
11010
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +000011011 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
11012 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
11013 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
11014 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
11015 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
11016 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011017 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000011018 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011019
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011020 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
11021 // create a built-in binary operator.
11022 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
11023 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
11024
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +000011025 // Build an empty overload set.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011026 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011027
11028 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011029 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011030
11031 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000011032 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011033
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000011034 // Add candidates from ADL.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011035 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011036 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +000011037 CandidateSet);
11038
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011039 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000011040 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011041
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011042 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11043
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011044 // Perform overload resolution.
11045 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011046 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +000011047 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011048 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
11049 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
11050
11051 if (FnDecl) {
11052 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
11053 // operator.
11054
11055 // Convert the arguments.
11056 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +000011057 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011058 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +000011059
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011060 ExprResult Arg1 =
11061 PerformCopyInitialization(
11062 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11063 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011064 SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011065 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011066 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011067
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011068 ExprResult Arg0 =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011069 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011070 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11071 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011072 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011073 Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
11074 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011075 } else {
11076 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011077 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
11078 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11079 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011080 SourceLocation(), Args[0]);
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011081 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011082 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011083
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011084 ExprResult Arg1 =
11085 PerformCopyInitialization(
11086 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11087 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011088 SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000011089 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
11090 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011091 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
11092 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011093 }
11094
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011095 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011096 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011097 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011098 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011099 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11100 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011101
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000011102 // Determine the result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011103 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000011104 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11105 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11106
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011107 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011108 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(),
Lang Hames5de91cc2012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011109 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
11110 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011111
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011112 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011113 FnDecl))
11114 return ExprError();
11115
Nick Lewyckyd24d5f22013-01-24 02:03:08 +000011116 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
11117 // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
11118 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl))
11119 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
11120 checkCall(FnDecl, ArgsArray, 0, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc,
11121 TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply);
11122
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011123 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011124 } else {
11125 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
11126 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
11127 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011128 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
11129 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
11130 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
11131 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011132 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011133 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011134
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011135 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
11136 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
11137 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
11138 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
11139 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011140 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011141 break;
11142 }
11143 }
11144
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011145 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
11146 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
11147 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
11148 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
11149 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011150 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011151 break;
11152
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011153 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
11154 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
11155 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011156 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011157 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011158 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +000011159 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
11160 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000011161 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmana31efa02013-08-28 20:35:35 +000011162 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) {
11163 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete)
11164 << Args[0]->getType()
11165 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11166 }
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011167 } else {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000011168 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
11169 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
11170 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011171 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000011172 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
11173 return ExprError();
11174
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011175 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
11176 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
11177 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +000011178 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011179 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011180 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
11181 if (Result.isInvalid())
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011182 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011183 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Benjamin Kramer62b95d82012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011184 return Result;
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011185 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011186
11187 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011188 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011189 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011190 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000011191 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011192 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011193 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011194 return ExprError();
11195
11196 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregor74f7d502012-02-15 19:33:52 +000011197 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
11198 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
11199 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
Richard Smithde1a4872012-12-28 12:23:24 +000011200 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
11201 << getSpecialMember(Method);
Richard Smith6f1e2c62012-04-02 20:59:25 +000011202
Richard Smithde1a4872012-12-28 12:23:24 +000011203 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
11204 // explain why it's deleted.
11205 NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
11206 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor74f7d502012-02-15 19:33:52 +000011207 } else {
11208 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11209 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
11210 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
11211 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11212 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11213 }
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011214 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +000011215 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011216 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +000011217 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011218
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000011219 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000011220 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000011221}
11222
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011223ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011224Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
11225 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011226 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
11227 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011228 DeclarationName OpName =
11229 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
11230
11231 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
11232 // expression.
11233 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
11234
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011235 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +000011236 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
11237 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
11238 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011239 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000011240 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011241 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000011242 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
11243 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
11244 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011245 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011246
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011247 return new (Context)
11248 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, Args,
11249 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, false);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011250 }
11251
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011252 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
11253 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
11254 return ExprError();
11255 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
11256 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011257
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011258 // Build an empty overload set.
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011259 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011260
11261 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
11262
11263 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000011264 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011265
11266 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000011267 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011268
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011269 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11270
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011271 // Perform overload resolution.
11272 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011273 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011274 case OR_Success: {
11275 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
11276 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
11277
11278 if (FnDecl) {
11279 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
11280 // operator.
11281
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011282 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +000011283
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011284 // Convert the arguments.
11285 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011286 ExprResult Arg0 =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011287 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011288 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11289 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011290 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011291 Args[0] = Arg0.get();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011292
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000011293 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011294 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000011295 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011296 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000011297 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011298 SourceLocation(),
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011299 Args[1]);
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000011300 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11301 return ExprError();
11302
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011303 Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000011304
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011305 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011306 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
11307 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011308 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011309 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011310 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011311 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11312 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011313 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11314 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011315
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000011316 // Determine the result type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011317 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
Richard Smithc1564702013-11-15 02:58:23 +000011318 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11319 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11320
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011321 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
11322 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011323 FnExpr.get(), Args,
Lang Hames5de91cc2012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011324 ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
11325 false);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011326
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011327 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011328 return ExprError();
11329
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011330 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011331 } else {
11332 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
11333 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
11334 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011335 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
11336 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
11337 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
11338 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011339 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011340 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011341
11342 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
11343 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
11344 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
11345 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
11346 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011347 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011348
11349 break;
11350 }
11351 }
11352
11353 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011354 if (CandidateSet.empty())
11355 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
11356 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
11357 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11358 else
11359 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
11360 << Args[0]->getType()
11361 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011362 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011363 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011364 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011365 }
11366
11367 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011368 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011369 << "[]"
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011370 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
11371 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011372 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011373 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011374 return ExprError();
11375
11376 case OR_Deleted:
11377 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11378 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011379 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011380 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011381 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011382 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011383 return ExprError();
11384 }
11385
11386 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011387 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011388}
11389
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011390/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
11391/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
11392/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
11393/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
11394/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011395/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
11396/// member function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011397ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011398Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011399 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
11400 MultiExprArg Args,
11401 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011402 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
11403 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
11404
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011405 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
11406 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011407 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011408
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011409 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
11410 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11411 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
11412 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
11413
11414 QualType fnType =
11415 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11416
11417 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11418 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011419 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType());
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011420
11421 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
11422 // member function we're calling.
11423 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
11424
11425 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
11426 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
11427 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11428 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
11429
11430 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
11431 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
11432 difference.removeAddressSpace();
11433 if (difference) {
11434 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
11435 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
11436 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
11437 << qualsString
11438 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
11439 }
Nick Lewycky35a6ef42014-01-11 02:50:57 +000011440
David Majnemerb3e56542014-08-07 22:56:13 +000011441 if (resultType->isMemberPointerType())
11442 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
11443 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, resultType, 0);
11444
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011445 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011446 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011447 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
11448
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011449 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011450 call, nullptr))
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011451 return ExprError();
11452
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011453 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011454 return ExprError();
11455
Richard Trieu9be9c682013-06-22 02:30:38 +000011456 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
11457 return ExprError();
11458
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011459 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
11460 }
11461
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011462 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011463 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011464 return ExprError();
11465
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011466 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011467 CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr;
11468 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public);
11469 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011470 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11471 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011472 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011473 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000011474 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011475 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011476 } else {
11477 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000011478 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011479
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011480 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011481 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
11482 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
11483 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011484
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011485 // Add overload candidates
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011486 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11487 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011488
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011489 // FIXME: avoid copy.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011490 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011491 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11492 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11493 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11494 }
11495
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011496 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
11497 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
11498
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011499 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
11500 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
11501 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
11502 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
11503
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011504
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +000011505 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +000011506 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011507 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011508 Args, CandidateSet);
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +000011509 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +000011510 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
11511 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011512 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +000011513 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011514
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011515 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011516 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011517 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011518 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011519 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011520 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011521 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011522 Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +000011523 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011524 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +000011525 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011526
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011527 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
11528
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011529 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11530
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011531 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011532 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +000011533 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011534 case OR_Success:
11535 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011536 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011537 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith22262ab2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000011538 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
11539 return ExprError();
Faisal Valid6676412013-06-15 11:54:37 +000011540 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
11541 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
11542 // called on both.
11543 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
11544 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
11545 // being used.
11546 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
11547 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
11548 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011549 break;
11550
11551 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011552 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011553 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +000011554 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011555 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011556 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011557 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011558
11559 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011560 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +000011561 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011562 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011563 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011564 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011565
11566 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011567 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011568 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011569 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011570 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011571 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011572 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011573 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011574 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011575 }
11576
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011577 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011578
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011579 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
11580 // non-member call based on that function.
11581 if (Method->isStatic()) {
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011582 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
11583 RParenLoc);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011584 }
11585
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011586 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011587 }
11588
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011589 QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType();
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011590 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
11591 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11592
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011593 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011594 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011595 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011596 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011597
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +000011598 // Check for a valid return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011599 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011600 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011601 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011602
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011603 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011604 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
11605 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011606 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
11607 ExprResult ObjectArg =
11608 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
11609 FoundDecl, Method);
11610 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
11611 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011612 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011613 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011614
11615 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011616 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11617 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011618 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011619 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011620 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011621
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011622 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
Eli Friedmanff4b4072012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011623
Richard Smith55ce3522012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011624 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011625 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +000011626
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011627 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
11628 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
11629 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
11630 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
11631
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +000011632 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011633 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
11634 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
11635 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
11636 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
11637
11638 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +000011639 }
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011640 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011641 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011642}
11643
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011644/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
11645/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
11646/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
11647/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000011648ExprResult
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011649Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +000011650 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011651 MultiExprArg Args,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011652 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011653 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
11654 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011655 ExprResult Object = Obj;
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011656
11657 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011658 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011659 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011660
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011661 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
11662 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011663
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011664 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
11665 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +000011666 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011667 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
11668 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
11669 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
11670 // (E).operator().
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011671 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc,
11672 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000011673 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011674
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011675 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011676 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011677 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011678
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011679 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11680 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
11681 R.suppressDiagnostics();
11682
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011683 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +000011684 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011685 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011686 Object.get()->Classify(Context),
11687 Args, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +000011688 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +000011689 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011690
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011691 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011692 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
11693 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011694 //
11695 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
11696 //
11697 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
11698 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +000011699 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
11700 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
11701 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
11702 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011703 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
11704 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
11705 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
11706 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
11707 // within T by another intervening declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +000011708 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
11709 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +000011710 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa6567c42012-11-28 03:56:09 +000011711 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
11712 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011713 NamedDecl *D = *I;
11714 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
11715 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
11716 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011717
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +000011718 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
11719 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011720 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +000011721 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +000011722
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011723 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011724 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
11725 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
11726 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
11727 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
11728 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
11729 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011730
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011731 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
11732 {
11733 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011734 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011735 }
11736 }
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011737 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011738
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011739 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11740
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011741 // Perform overload resolution.
11742 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011743 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011744 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011745 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011746 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
11747 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011748 break;
11749
11750 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011751 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011752 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011753 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
11754 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011755 else
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011756 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011757 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011758 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011759 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011760 break;
11761
11762 case OR_Ambiguous:
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011763 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011764 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011765 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011766 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011767 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011768
11769 case OR_Deleted:
Daniel Dunbar62ee6412012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011770 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011771 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
11772 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011773 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011774 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011775 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011776 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011777 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011778 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011779
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +000011780 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011781 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011782
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011783 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11784
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011785 if (Best->Function == nullptr) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011786 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
11787 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011788 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011789 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
11790 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
11791
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011792 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr,
11793 Best->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith22262ab2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000011794 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
11795 return ExprError();
Faisal Valid6676412013-06-15 11:54:37 +000011796 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
11797 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011798 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
11799 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
11800 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011801
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +000011802 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +000011803 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011804 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
11805 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011806 if (Call.isInvalid())
11807 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +000011808 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000011809 Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
11810 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(),
11811 nullptr, VK_RValue);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011812
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011813 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011814 }
11815
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011816 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011817
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011818 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
11819 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
11820 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
11821 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Nico Weber1fefe412012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011822
11823 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
Nico Weber9512d3f2012-11-09 08:38:04 +000011824 if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
Nico Weber1fefe412012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011825 return ExprError();
11826
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011827 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11828 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011829
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +000011830 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011831
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011832 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
11833 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
11834 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011835 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011836 HadMultipleCandidates,
11837 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11838 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011839 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11840 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011841
Benjamin Kramer8b1a6bd2013-09-25 13:10:11 +000011842 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object
11843 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list).
Ahmed Charlesaf94d562014-03-09 11:34:25 +000011844 std::unique_ptr<Expr * []> MethodArgs(new Expr *[Args.size() + 1]);
Benjamin Kramer8b1a6bd2013-09-25 13:10:11 +000011845 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
11846 std::copy(Args.begin(), Args.end(), &MethodArgs[1]);
11847
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011848 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
11849 // owned.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011850 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011851 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11852 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11853
Benjamin Kramer8b1a6bd2013-09-25 13:10:11 +000011854 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = new (Context)
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011855 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(),
Benjamin Kramer8b1a6bd2013-09-25 13:10:11 +000011856 llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs.get(), Args.size() + 1),
11857 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
11858 MethodArgs.reset();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011859
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000011860 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method))
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +000011861 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011862
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011863 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
11864 // slots in the call for them.
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +000011865 if (Args.size() < NumParams)
11866 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011867
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011868 bool IsError = false;
11869
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011870 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011871 ExprResult ObjRes =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011872 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011873 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11874 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
11875 IsError = true;
11876 else
Benjamin Kramer62b95d82012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011877 Object = ObjRes;
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011878 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.get());
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011879
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011880 // Check the argument types.
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +000011881 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011882 Expr *Arg;
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011883 if (i < Args.size()) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011884 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011885
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011886 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011887
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011888 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011889 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011890 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011891 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011892 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011893
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011894 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011895 Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011896 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011897 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011898 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
11899 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
11900 IsError = true;
11901 break;
11902 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011903
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011904 Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011905 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011906
11907 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
11908 }
11909
11910 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
11911 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
11912 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +000011913 for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000011914 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
11915 nullptr);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011916 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000011917 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.get());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011918 }
11919 }
11920
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011921 if (IsError) return true;
11922
Dmitri Gribenkod3b75562013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011923 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
Eli Friedmanff4b4072012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011924
Richard Smith55ce3522012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011925 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +000011926 return true;
11927
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +000011928 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011929}
11930
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011931/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011932/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011933/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011934ExprResult
Kaelyn Uhrain0c51de42013-07-31 17:38:24 +000011935Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11936 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011937 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11938 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011939
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011940 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
11941 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011942
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011943 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
11944
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011945 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
11946 //
11947 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
11948 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
11949 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
11950 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011951 DeclarationName OpName =
11952 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000011953 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +000011954 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011955
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011956 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Douglas Gregor7bfb2d02012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011957 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +000011958 return ExprError();
11959
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011960 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11961 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
11962 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +000011963
11964 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011965 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011966 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
Dmitri Gribenko44ebbd52013-05-05 00:41:58 +000011967 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011968 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011969
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011970 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11971
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011972 // Perform overload resolution.
11973 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011974 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011975 case OR_Success:
11976 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
11977 break;
11978
11979 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Kaelyn Uhrain1bb5dbf2013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011980 if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
11981 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
Kaelyn Uhrain0c51de42013-07-31 17:38:24 +000011982 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) {
11983 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a
11984 // diagnostic, as requested.
11985 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true;
11986 return ExprError();
11987 }
Kaelyn Uhrainbad7fb02013-07-15 19:54:54 +000011988 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
11989 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange();
Kaelyn Uhrain1bb5dbf2013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011990 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrainbad7fb02013-07-15 19:54:54 +000011991 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
Kaelyn Uhrain1bb5dbf2013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011992 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
Kaelyn Uhrain1bb5dbf2013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011993 }
11994 } else
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011995 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011996 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011997 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011998 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011999
12000 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000012001 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
12002 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000012003 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000012004 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000012005
12006 case OR_Deleted:
12007 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
12008 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000012009 << "->"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000012010 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000012011 << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charlesb24b9aa2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000012012 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000012013 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000012014 }
12015
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012016 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000012017
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000012018 // Convert the object parameter.
12019 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000012020 ExprResult BaseResult =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012021 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000012022 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
12023 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000012024 return ExprError();
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000012025 Base = BaseResult.get();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +000012026
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000012027 // Build the operator call.
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000012028 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000012029 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000012030 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
12031 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012032
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000012033 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000012034 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12035 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000012036 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000012037 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(),
Lang Hames5de91cc2012-10-02 04:45:10 +000012038 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000012039
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000012040 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method))
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000012041 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman2d9c47e2011-04-04 01:18:25 +000012042
12043 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000012044}
12045
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012046/// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
12047/// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
12048ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
12049 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
12050 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
12051 SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
12052 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
12053 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012054
Richard Smith100b24a2014-04-17 01:52:14 +000012055 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc,
12056 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012057 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true,
12058 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012059
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012060 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
12061
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012062 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
12063 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
12064 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12065 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
12066 case OR_Success:
12067 case OR_Deleted:
12068 break;
12069
12070 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
12071 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
12072 << R.getLookupName();
12073 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
12074 return ExprError();
12075
12076 case OR_Ambiguous:
12077 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
12078 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
12079 return ExprError();
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012080 }
12081
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012082 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
Nick Lewycky134af912013-02-07 05:08:22 +000012083 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
12084 HadMultipleCandidates,
Richard Smithbcc22fc2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000012085 SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
12086 SuffixInfo.getInfo());
12087 if (Fn.isInvalid())
12088 return true;
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012089
12090 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
12091 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012092 Expr *ConvArgs[2];
Richard Smithe54c3072013-05-05 15:51:06 +000012093 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012094 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
12095 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
12096 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
12097 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
12098 return true;
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000012099 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get();
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012100 }
12101
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000012102 QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType();
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012103 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12104 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
12105
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012106 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
Nikola Smiljanic01a75982014-05-29 10:55:11 +000012107 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.get(),
Benjamin Kramerc215e762012-08-24 11:54:20 +000012108 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012109 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
12110
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +000012111 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012112 return ExprError();
12113
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012114 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr))
Richard Smithc67fdd42012-03-07 08:35:16 +000012115 return ExprError();
12116
12117 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
12118}
12119
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012120/// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
12121/// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
12122/// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
12123/// dependent lookup.
12124/// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
12125/// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
12126/// is returned.
12127Sema::ForRangeStatus
12128Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
12129 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl,
12130 BeginEndFunction BEF,
12131 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
12132 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
12133 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
12134 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
12135 CandidateSet->clear();
12136 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
12137 ExprResult MemberRef =
12138 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
12139 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
12140 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012141 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012142 MemberLookup,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012143 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012144 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
12145 *CallExpr = ExprError();
12146 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
12147 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
12148 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12149 }
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012150 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr);
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012151 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
12152 *CallExpr = ExprError();
12153 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
12154 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
12155 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12156 }
12157 } else {
12158 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012159 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012160 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/nullptr,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012161 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
12162 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
Richard Smithb6626742012-10-18 17:56:02 +000012163 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012164
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000012165 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012166 CandidateSet, CallExpr);
12167 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
12168 *CallExpr = ExprError();
12169 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
12170 }
12171 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12172 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
12173 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
12174
12175 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
12176 *CallExpr = ExprError();
12177 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
12178 }
Dmitri Gribenko9c785c22013-05-09 21:02:07 +000012179 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012180 Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best,
Sam Panzer0f384432012-08-21 00:52:01 +000012181 OverloadResult,
12182 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
12183 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
12184 *CallExpr = ExprError();
12185 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
12186 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
12187 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12188 }
12189 }
12190 return FRS_Success;
12191}
12192
12193
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000012194/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
12195/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
12196/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
12197/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +000012198/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +000012199Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012200 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000012201 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012202 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
12203 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012204 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012205 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012206
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012207 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012208 }
12209
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012210 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012211 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
12212 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012213 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012214 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +000012215 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +000012216 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012217 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012218 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012219
12220 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +000012221 ICE->getCastKind(),
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012222 SubExpr, nullptr,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000012223 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012224 }
12225
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012226 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000012227 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000012228 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +000012229 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
12230 if (Method->isStatic()) {
12231 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
12232 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000012233 } else {
Alp Toker028ed912013-12-06 17:56:43 +000012234 // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000012235 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
12236 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012237 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
12238 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000012239 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012240 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012241
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000012242 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
12243 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
12244 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
12245 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
12246
12247 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
12248 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
12249 // appropriate pointer to member type.
12250 QualType ClassType
12251 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
12252 QualType MemPtrType
12253 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
12254
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000012255 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
12256 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
12257 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +000012258 }
12259 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012260 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
12261 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012262 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012263 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012264
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000012265 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012266 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000012267 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012268 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012269 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000012270
12271 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012272 // FIXME: avoid copy.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012273 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000012274 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012275 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
12276 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000012277 }
12278
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012279 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
12280 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000012281 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012282 Fn,
John McCall113bee02012-03-10 09:33:50 +000012283 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012284 ULE->getNameLoc(),
12285 Fn->getType(),
12286 VK_LValue,
12287 Found.getDecl(),
12288 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +000012289 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012290 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
12291 return DRE;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000012292 }
12293
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000012294 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000012295 // FIXME: avoid copy.
Craig Topperc3ec1492014-05-26 06:22:03 +000012296 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012297 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12298 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
12299 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
12300 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000012301
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012302 Expr *Base;
12303
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000012304 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
12305 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012306 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
12307 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012308 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
12309 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000012310 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012311 Fn,
John McCall113bee02012-03-10 09:33:50 +000012312 /*enclosing*/ false,
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012313 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
12314 Fn->getType(),
12315 VK_LValue,
12316 Found.getDecl(),
12317 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +000012318 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012319 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
12320 return DRE;
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +000012321 } else {
12322 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
12323 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000012324 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman73a04092012-01-07 04:59:52 +000012325 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +000012326 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
12327 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
12328 /*isImplicit=*/true);
12329 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012330 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012331 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000012332
John McCall4adb38c2011-04-27 00:36:17 +000012333 ExprValueKind valueKind;
12334 QualType type;
12335 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
12336 valueKind = VK_LValue;
12337 type = Fn->getType();
12338 } else {
12339 valueKind = VK_RValue;
12340 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
12341 }
12342
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012343 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
12344 MemExpr->isArrow(),
12345 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000012346 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012347 Fn,
12348 Found,
12349 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
12350 TemplateArgs,
12351 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
12352 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Richard Smith4f6a2c42012-11-14 07:06:31 +000012353 MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012354 return ME;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012355 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012356
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012357 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000012358}
12359
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012360ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000012361 DeclAccessPair Found,
12362 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Nikola Smiljanic03ff2592014-05-29 14:05:12 +000012363 return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +000012364}
12365
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000012366} // end namespace clang